OpenCores
URL https://opencores.org/ocsvn/openrisc_2011-10-31/openrisc_2011-10-31/trunk

Subversion Repositories openrisc_2011-10-31

[/] [openrisc/] [trunk/] [gnu-src/] [gdb-7.1/] [gdb/] [breakpoint.c] - Blame information for rev 595

Go to most recent revision | Details | Compare with Previous | View Log

Line No. Rev Author Line
1 227 jeremybenn
/* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
 
3
   Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4
   1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5
   2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
 
7
   This file is part of GDB.
8
 
9
   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10
   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11
   the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12
   (at your option) any later version.
13
 
14
   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15
   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16
   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
17
   GNU General Public License for more details.
18
 
19
   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20
   along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.  */
21
 
22
#include "defs.h"
23
#include "arch-utils.h"
24
#include <ctype.h>
25
#include "hashtab.h"
26
#include "symtab.h"
27
#include "frame.h"
28
#include "breakpoint.h"
29
#include "tracepoint.h"
30
#include "gdbtypes.h"
31
#include "expression.h"
32
#include "gdbcore.h"
33
#include "gdbcmd.h"
34
#include "value.h"
35
#include "command.h"
36
#include "inferior.h"
37
#include "gdbthread.h"
38
#include "target.h"
39
#include "language.h"
40
#include "gdb_string.h"
41
#include "demangle.h"
42
#include "annotate.h"
43
#include "symfile.h"
44
#include "objfiles.h"
45
#include "source.h"
46
#include "linespec.h"
47
#include "completer.h"
48
#include "gdb.h"
49
#include "ui-out.h"
50
#include "cli/cli-script.h"
51
#include "gdb_assert.h"
52
#include "block.h"
53
#include "solib.h"
54
#include "solist.h"
55
#include "observer.h"
56
#include "exceptions.h"
57
#include "memattr.h"
58
#include "ada-lang.h"
59
#include "top.h"
60
#include "wrapper.h"
61
#include "valprint.h"
62
#include "jit.h"
63
#include "xml-syscall.h"
64
 
65
/* readline include files */
66
#include "readline/readline.h"
67
#include "readline/history.h"
68
 
69
/* readline defines this.  */
70
#undef savestring
71
 
72
#include "mi/mi-common.h"
73
 
74
/* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers.  */
75
#define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
76
#define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
77
 
78
/* Prototypes for local functions. */
79
 
80
static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
81
 
82
static void enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
83
 
84
static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
85
 
86
static void enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
87
 
88
static void disable_command (char *, int);
89
 
90
static void enable_command (char *, int);
91
 
92
static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*)(struct breakpoint *));
93
 
94
static void ignore_command (char *, int);
95
 
96
static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
97
 
98
static void clear_command (char *, int);
99
 
100
static void catch_command (char *, int);
101
 
102
static void watch_command (char *, int);
103
 
104
static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
105
 
106
static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
107
 
108
static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
109
 
110
/* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static.  */
111
struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
112
                                              struct symtab_and_line,
113
                                              enum bptype);
114
 
115
static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
116
 
117
static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
118
                                            CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
119
                                            enum bptype bptype);
120
 
121
static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
122
                                        struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
123
                                        struct obj_section *, int);
124
 
125
static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
126
                                     CORE_ADDR addr1,
127
                                     struct address_space *aspace2,
128
                                     CORE_ADDR addr2);
129
 
130
static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
131
 
132
static void breakpoint_1 (int, int);
133
 
134
static bpstat bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *, bpstat);
135
 
136
static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
137
 
138
static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
139
 
140
static void commands_command (char *, int);
141
 
142
static void condition_command (char *, int);
143
 
144
static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
145
 
146
void set_breakpoint_count (int);
147
 
148
typedef enum
149
  {
150
    mark_inserted,
151
    mark_uninserted
152
  }
153
insertion_state_t;
154
 
155
static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
156
static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
157
 
158
static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
159
 
160
static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
161
 
162
static int watchpoint_check (void *);
163
 
164
static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
165
 
166
static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
167
 
168
static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
169
 
170
static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
171
 
172
static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
173
 
174
static void watch_command_1 (char *, int, int);
175
 
176
static void rwatch_command (char *, int);
177
 
178
static void awatch_command (char *, int);
179
 
180
static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
181
 
182
static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
183
 
184
static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
185
 
186
static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
187
 
188
static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
189
 
190
static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
191
                                       char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
192
 
193
static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
194
 
195
static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
196
 
197
static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
198
                                                   CORE_ADDR pc);
199
 
200
static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
201
 
202
static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
203
 
204
static void update_global_location_list (int);
205
 
206
static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
207
 
208
static int is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
209
 
210
static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
211
 
212
static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
213
 
214
static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
215
 
216
static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
217
 
218
static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
219
 
220
static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
221
 
222
static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
223
 
224
static void skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal);
225
 
226
 
227
/* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
228
   current breakpoint.  */
229
 
230
static int breakpoint_proceeded;
231
 
232
static const char *
233
bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
234
{
235
  /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and represent
236
     values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at a breakpoint.  */
237
  static char *bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
238
  return bpdisps[(int) disp];
239
}
240
 
241
/* Prototypes for exported functions. */
242
/* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
243
   if such is available. */
244
static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
245
 
246
static void
247
show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
248
                             struct cmd_list_element *c,
249
                             const char *value)
250
{
251
  fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
252
Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
253
                    value);
254
}
255
 
256
/* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
257
   If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
258
   for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
259
   If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized.  */
260
static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
261
static void
262
show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
263
                            struct cmd_list_element *c,
264
                            const char *value)
265
{
266
  fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
267
Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
268
                    value);
269
}
270
 
271
/* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
272
   set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
273
   If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
274
   use hardware breakpoints.  */
275
static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
276
static void
277
show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
278
                                     struct cmd_list_element *c,
279
                                     const char *value)
280
{
281
  fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
282
Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
283
                    value);
284
}
285
 
286
/* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
287
   stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints.  If off, gdb
288
   will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
289
   will remove breakpoints upon stop.  If auto, GDB will behave as ON
290
   if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
291
 
292
static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
293
static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
294
static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
295
static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
296
  always_inserted_auto,
297
  always_inserted_off,
298
  always_inserted_on,
299
  NULL
300
};
301
static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
302
static void
303
show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
304
                     struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
305
{
306
  if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
307
    fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
308
Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
309
                      value,
310
                      breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
311
  else
312
    fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
313
}
314
 
315
int
316
breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
317
{
318
  return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
319
          || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
320
}
321
 
322
void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
323
 
324
/* Are we executing breakpoint commands?  */
325
static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
326
 
327
/* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
328
static int overlay_events_enabled;
329
 
330
/* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
331
   ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the current
332
   breakpoint.  */
333
 
334
#define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B)  for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
335
 
336
#define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP)     \
337
        for (B = breakpoint_chain;      \
338
             B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0;    \
339
             B = TMP)
340
 
341
/* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints.  SAFE variant is not
342
   provided so update_global_location_list must not be called while executing
343
   the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS.  */
344
 
345
#define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP)                                      \
346
        for (BP_TMP = bp_location;                                      \
347
             BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
348
             BP_TMP++)
349
 
350
/* Iterator for tracepoints only.  */
351
 
352
#define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B)  \
353
  for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)  \
354
    if (tracepoint_type (B))
355
 
356
/* Chains of all breakpoints defined.  */
357
 
358
struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
359
 
360
/* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS.  */
361
 
362
static struct bp_location **bp_location;
363
 
364
/* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION.  */
365
 
366
static unsigned bp_location_count;
367
 
368
/* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and ADDRESS
369
   for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
370
   bp_location_has_shadow.  You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
371
   BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read.  */
372
 
373
static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
374
 
375
/* Maximum offset plus alignment between
376
   bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for
377
   the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
378
   bp_location_has_shadow.  You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
379
   BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read.  */
380
 
381
static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
382
 
383
/* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint,
384
   unlinked from bp_location array, but for which a hit
385
   may still be reported by a target.  */
386
VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
387
 
388
/* Number of last breakpoint made.  */
389
 
390
int breakpoint_count;
391
 
392
/* Number of last tracepoint made.  */
393
 
394
int tracepoint_count;
395
 
396
/* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint.  */
397
static int
398
breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
399
{
400
  return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
401
}
402
 
403
/* Set breakpoint count to NUM.  */
404
 
405
void
406
set_breakpoint_count (int num)
407
{
408
  breakpoint_count = num;
409
  set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
410
}
411
 
412
/* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
413
 
414
void
415
clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
416
{
417
  struct breakpoint *b;
418
 
419
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
420
    b->hit_count = 0;
421
}
422
 
423
/* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints.  */
424
 
425
static int
426
tracepoint_type (const struct breakpoint *b)
427
{
428
  return (b->type == bp_tracepoint || b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint);
429
}
430
 
431
/* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
432
   for "break" command with no arg.
433
   if default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
434
   not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
435
 
436
   This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint.  */
437
 
438
int default_breakpoint_valid;
439
CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
440
struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
441
int default_breakpoint_line;
442
struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
443
 
444
 
445
/* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint.  Get the number of the breakpoint.
446
   Advance *PP after the string and any trailing whitespace.
447
 
448
   Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the name
449
   of a convenience variable.  Making it an expression wouldn't work well
450
   for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
451
 
452
   If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
453
 
454
   TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
455
   commonly this is `-'.  If you don't want a trailer, use \0.  */
456
static int
457
get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
458
{
459
  int retval = 0;        /* default */
460
  char *p = *pp;
461
 
462
  if (p == NULL)
463
    /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint.  */
464
    return breakpoint_count;
465
  else if (*p == '$')
466
    {
467
      /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
468
         to pass to lookup_internalvar().  */
469
      char *varname;
470
      char *start = ++p;
471
      LONGEST val;
472
 
473
      while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
474
        p++;
475
      varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
476
      strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
477
      varname[p - start] = '\0';
478
      if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
479
        retval = (int) val;
480
      else
481
        {
482
          printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
483
          retval = 0;
484
        }
485
    }
486
  else
487
    {
488
      if (*p == '-')
489
        ++p;
490
      while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
491
        ++p;
492
      if (p == *pp)
493
        /* There is no number here.  (e.g. "cond a == b").  */
494
        {
495
          /* Skip non-numeric token */
496
          while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
497
            ++p;
498
          /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
499
          retval = 0;
500
        }
501
      else
502
        retval = atoi (*pp);
503
    }
504
  if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
505
    {
506
      /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
507
      while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
508
        ++p;
509
      retval = 0;
510
    }
511
  while (isspace (*p))
512
    p++;
513
  *pp = p;
514
  return retval;
515
}
516
 
517
 
518
/* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer.  */
519
int
520
get_number (char **pp)
521
{
522
  return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
523
}
524
 
525
/* Parse a number or a range.
526
 * A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
527
 * A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
528
 * will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
529
 * inclusive.
530
 *
531
 * While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
532
 * At each call it will return the next value in the range.
533
 *
534
 * At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
535
 * be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
536
 * Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
537
 * is completed.  The call that completes the range will advance
538
 * pointer PP past <number2>.
539
 */
540
 
541
int
542
get_number_or_range (char **pp)
543
{
544
  static int last_retval, end_value;
545
  static char *end_ptr;
546
  static int in_range = 0;
547
 
548
  if (**pp != '-')
549
    {
550
      /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
551
         or to the first number of a range.  */
552
      last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
553
      if (**pp == '-')
554
        {
555
          char **temp;
556
 
557
          /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
558
             Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
559
             and also remember the end of the final token.  */
560
 
561
          temp = &end_ptr;
562
          end_ptr = *pp + 1;
563
          while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
564
            end_ptr++;  /* skip white space */
565
          end_value = get_number (temp);
566
          if (end_value < last_retval)
567
            {
568
              error (_("inverted range"));
569
            }
570
          else if (end_value == last_retval)
571
            {
572
              /* degenerate range (number1 == number2).  Advance the
573
                 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
574
                 single number.  */
575
              *pp = end_ptr;
576
            }
577
          else
578
            in_range = 1;
579
        }
580
    }
581
  else if (! in_range)
582
    error (_("negative value"));
583
  else
584
    {
585
      /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range.  All
586
         number-parsing has already been done.  Return the next
587
         integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
588
         Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
589
         is reached.  */
590
 
591
      if (++last_retval == end_value)
592
        {
593
          /* End of range reached; advance token pointer.  */
594
          *pp = end_ptr;
595
          in_range = 0;
596
        }
597
    }
598
  return last_retval;
599
}
600
 
601
/* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
602
   if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint.  */
603
 
604
struct breakpoint *
605
get_breakpoint (int num)
606
{
607
  struct breakpoint *b;
608
 
609
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
610
    if (b->number == num)
611
      return b;
612
 
613
  return NULL;
614
}
615
 
616
 
617
/* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP.  */
618
 
619
static void
620
condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
621
{
622
  struct breakpoint *b;
623
  char *p;
624
  int bnum;
625
 
626
  if (arg == 0)
627
    error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
628
 
629
  p = arg;
630
  bnum = get_number (&p);
631
  if (bnum == 0)
632
    error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
633
 
634
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
635
    if (b->number == bnum)
636
      {
637
        struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
638
        for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
639
          {
640
            if (loc->cond)
641
              {
642
                xfree (loc->cond);
643
                loc->cond = 0;
644
              }
645
          }
646
        if (b->cond_string != NULL)
647
          xfree (b->cond_string);
648
 
649
        if (*p == 0)
650
          {
651
            b->cond_string = NULL;
652
            if (from_tty)
653
              printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), bnum);
654
          }
655
        else
656
          {
657
            arg = p;
658
            /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
659
               typed in or the decompiled expression.  */
660
            b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
661
            b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
662
            for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
663
              {
664
                arg = p;
665
                loc->cond =
666
                  parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
667
                if (*arg)
668
                  error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
669
              }
670
          }
671
        breakpoints_changed ();
672
        observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
673
        return;
674
      }
675
 
676
  error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
677
}
678
 
679
/* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS.  */
680
 
681
void
682
breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, struct command_line *commands)
683
{
684
  free_command_lines (&b->commands);
685
  b->commands = commands;
686
  breakpoints_changed ();
687
  observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
688
}
689
 
690
static void
691
commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
692
{
693
  struct breakpoint *b;
694
  char *p;
695
  int bnum;
696
  struct command_line *l;
697
 
698
  /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
699
     free the storage, if we change the commands currently
700
     being read from.  */
701
 
702
  if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
703
    error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
704
 
705
  p = arg;
706
  bnum = get_number (&p);
707
 
708
  if (p && *p)
709
    error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
710
 
711
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
712
    if (b->number == bnum)
713
      {
714
        char *tmpbuf = xstrprintf ("Type commands for when breakpoint %d is hit, one per line.",
715
                                 bnum);
716
        struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, tmpbuf);
717
        l = read_command_lines (tmpbuf, from_tty, 1);
718
        do_cleanups (cleanups);
719
        breakpoint_set_commands (b, l);
720
        return;
721
    }
722
  error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
723
}
724
 
725
/* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
726
   input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
727
 
728
   This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
729
   that are part of if and while bodies.  */
730
enum command_control_type
731
commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
732
{
733
  struct breakpoint *b;
734
  char *p;
735
  int bnum;
736
 
737
  /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
738
     free the storage, if we change the commands currently
739
     being read from.  */
740
 
741
  if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
742
    error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
743
 
744
  /* An empty string for the breakpoint number means the last
745
     breakpoint, but get_number expects a NULL pointer.  */
746
  if (arg && !*arg)
747
    p = NULL;
748
  else
749
    p = arg;
750
  bnum = get_number (&p);
751
 
752
  if (p && *p)
753
    error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
754
 
755
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
756
    if (b->number == bnum)
757
      {
758
        free_command_lines (&b->commands);
759
        if (cmd->body_count != 1)
760
          error (_("Invalid \"commands\" block structure."));
761
        /* We need to copy the commands because if/while will free the
762
           list after it finishes execution.  */
763
        b->commands = copy_command_lines (cmd->body_list[0]);
764
        breakpoints_changed ();
765
        observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
766
        return simple_control;
767
      }
768
  error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
769
}
770
 
771
/* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information.  */
772
 
773
static int
774
bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
775
{
776
  if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
777
    return 0;
778
  if (!bl->inserted)
779
    return 0;
780
  if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
781
    /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory.  */
782
    return 0;
783
  return 1;
784
}
785
 
786
/* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
787
   by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
788
 
789
   The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
790
     b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
791
     up to b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
792
   The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
793
     memaddr ... memaddr + len
794
   Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
795
     memaddr + len <= b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
796
   and:
797
     b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr  */
798
 
799
void
800
breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
801
{
802
  /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary search.  */
803
  unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
804
 
805
  /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF content.  It is
806
     safe to report lower value but a failure to report higher one.  */
807
 
808
  bc_l = 0;
809
  bc_r = bp_location_count;
810
  while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
811
    {
812
      struct bp_location *b;
813
 
814
      bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
815
      b = bp_location[bc];
816
 
817
      /* Check first B->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added constant.
818
         Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure the BC element can
819
         in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR to MEMADDR + LEN range).
820
 
821
         Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety offset so that
822
         we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow range tail still reaching
823
         MEMADDR.  */
824
 
825
      if (b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max >= b->address
826
          && b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr)
827
        bc_l = bc;
828
      else
829
        bc_r = bc;
830
    }
831
 
832
  /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements.  */
833
 
834
  for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
835
  {
836
    struct bp_location *b = bp_location[bc];
837
    CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
838
    int bp_size = 0;
839
    int bptoffset = 0;
840
 
841
    if (b->owner->type == bp_none)
842
      warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
843
              b->owner->number);
844
 
845
    /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
846
       content.  */
847
 
848
    if (b->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
849
        && memaddr + len <= b->address
850
                            - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
851
      break;
852
 
853
    if (!bp_location_has_shadow (b))
854
      continue;
855
    if (!breakpoint_address_match (b->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
856
                                   current_program_space->aspace, 0))
857
      continue;
858
 
859
    /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
860
       we need to copy.  */
861
    bp_addr = b->target_info.placed_address;
862
    bp_size = b->target_info.shadow_len;
863
 
864
    if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
865
      /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
866
         are reading.  */
867
      continue;
868
 
869
    if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
870
      /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
871
         reading. */
872
      continue;
873
 
874
    /* Offset within shadow_contents.  */
875
    if (bp_addr < memaddr)
876
      {
877
        /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint.  */
878
        bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
879
        bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
880
        bp_addr = memaddr;
881
      }
882
 
883
    if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
884
      {
885
        /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint.  */
886
        bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
887
      }
888
 
889
    memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
890
            b->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
891
  }
892
}
893
 
894
 
895
/* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints.  */
896
static void
897
insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
898
{
899
  struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
900
  int val = -1;
901
 
902
  gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
903
  gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
904
 
905
  b->ops->insert (b);
906
}
907
 
908
static int
909
is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
910
{
911
  return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
912
          || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
913
          || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
914
}
915
 
916
/* Find the current value of a watchpoint on EXP.  Return the value in
917
   *VALP and *RESULTP and the chain of intermediate and final values
918
   in *VAL_CHAIN.  RESULTP and VAL_CHAIN may be NULL if the caller does
919
   not need them.
920
 
921
   If a memory error occurs while evaluating the expression, *RESULTP will
922
   be set to NULL.  *RESULTP may be a lazy value, if the result could
923
   not be read from memory.  It is used to determine whether a value
924
   is user-specified (we should watch the whole value) or intermediate
925
   (we should watch only the bit used to locate the final value).
926
 
927
   If the final value, or any intermediate value, could not be read
928
   from memory, *VALP will be set to NULL.  *VAL_CHAIN will still be
929
   set to any referenced values.  *VALP will never be a lazy value.
930
   This is the value which we store in struct breakpoint.
931
 
932
   If VAL_CHAIN is non-NULL, *VAL_CHAIN will be released from the
933
   value chain.  The caller must free the values individually.  If
934
   VAL_CHAIN is NULL, all generated values will be left on the value
935
   chain.  */
936
 
937
static void
938
fetch_watchpoint_value (struct expression *exp, struct value **valp,
939
                        struct value **resultp, struct value **val_chain)
940
{
941
  struct value *mark, *new_mark, *result;
942
  volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
943
 
944
  *valp = NULL;
945
  if (resultp)
946
    *resultp = NULL;
947
  if (val_chain)
948
    *val_chain = NULL;
949
 
950
  /* Evaluate the expression.  */
951
  mark = value_mark ();
952
  result = NULL;
953
 
954
  TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
955
    {
956
      result = evaluate_expression (exp);
957
    }
958
  if (ex.reason < 0)
959
    {
960
      /* Ignore memory errors, we want watchpoints pointing at
961
         inaccessible memory to still be created; otherwise, throw the
962
         error to some higher catcher.  */
963
      switch (ex.error)
964
        {
965
        case MEMORY_ERROR:
966
          break;
967
        default:
968
          throw_exception (ex);
969
          break;
970
        }
971
    }
972
 
973
  new_mark = value_mark ();
974
  if (mark == new_mark)
975
    return;
976
  if (resultp)
977
    *resultp = result;
978
 
979
  /* Make sure it's not lazy, so that after the target stops again we
980
     have a non-lazy previous value to compare with.  */
981
  if (result != NULL
982
      && (!value_lazy (result) || gdb_value_fetch_lazy (result)))
983
    *valp = result;
984
 
985
  if (val_chain)
986
    {
987
      /* Return the chain of intermediate values.  We use this to
988
         decide which addresses to watch.  */
989
      *val_chain = new_mark;
990
      value_release_to_mark (mark);
991
    }
992
}
993
 
994
/* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
995
   and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
996
   Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
997
   context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
998
   created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
999
   the correct frame context.  Watchpoints on global expressions can
1000
   be evaluated on any thread, and in any state.  It is presently left
1001
   to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
1002
   running.  */
1003
 
1004
static int
1005
watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1006
{
1007
  return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1008
          || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1009
              && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1010
}
1011
 
1012
/* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1013
   - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1014
   - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1015
   - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1016
     in b->loc->cond.
1017
   - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1018
 
1019
   If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do nothing.
1020
   If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete it.
1021
 
1022
   Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are removed
1023
   + inserted on each stop here.  Normal breakpoints must never be removed
1024
   because they might be missed by a running thread when debugging in non-stop
1025
   mode.  On the other hand, hardware watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint;
1026
   processed here) are specific to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's
1027
   hardware debug registers.  Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in
1028
   order to be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1029
 
1030
   Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being presented to the
1031
   user.  It cannot be done sooner, because it would reset the data used to
1032
   present the watchpoint hit to the user.  And it must not be done later
1033
   because it could display the same single watchpoint hit during multiple GDB
1034
   stops.  Note that the latter is relevant only to the hardware watchpoint
1035
   types bp_read_watchpoint and bp_access_watchpoint.  False hit by
1036
   bp_hardware_watchpoint is not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the
1037
   memory content has not changed.
1038
 
1039
   The following constraints influence the location where we can reset hardware
1040
   watchpoints:
1041
 
1042
   * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are called
1043
     several times when GDB stops.
1044
 
1045
   [linux]
1046
   * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, causing GDB to
1047
     stop.  GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint hit at a time as the
1048
     reason for stopping, and all the other hits are presented later, one after
1049
     the other, each time the user requests the execution to be resumed.
1050
     Execution is not resumed for the threads still having pending hit event
1051
     stored in LWP_INFO->STATUS.  While the watchpoint is already removed from
1052
     the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being reported
1053
     from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address until the real
1054
     thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets presented and thus its
1055
     LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1056
 
1057
   Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the watchpoint
1058
   removal from inferior.  */
1059
 
1060
static void
1061
update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1062
{
1063
  int within_current_scope;
1064
  struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1065
  struct bp_location *loc;
1066
  int frame_saved;
1067
  bpstat bs;
1068
 
1069
  /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1070
     watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1071
     that was used to create the watchpoint.  */
1072
  if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1073
    return;
1074
 
1075
  /* We don't free locations.  They are stored in bp_location array and
1076
     update_global_locations will eventually delete them and remove
1077
     breakpoints if needed.  */
1078
  b->loc = NULL;
1079
 
1080
  if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1081
    return;
1082
 
1083
  frame_saved = 0;
1084
 
1085
  /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope.  */
1086
  if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1087
    within_current_scope = 1;
1088
  else
1089
    {
1090
      struct frame_info *fi;
1091
 
1092
      /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1093
         evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame.  */
1094
      /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1095
         took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1096
         selected frame.  */
1097
      frame_saved = 1;
1098
      saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1099
 
1100
      fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1101
      within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1102
      if (within_current_scope)
1103
        select_frame (fi);
1104
    }
1105
 
1106
  if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1107
    {
1108
      char *s;
1109
      if (b->exp)
1110
        {
1111
          xfree (b->exp);
1112
          b->exp = NULL;
1113
        }
1114
      s = b->exp_string;
1115
      b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1116
      /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1117
         no longer relevant.  We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1118
         to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1119
         be completely different objects.  */
1120
      value_free (b->val);
1121
      b->val = NULL;
1122
      b->val_valid = 0;
1123
    }
1124
 
1125
  /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1126
     it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1127
     don't try to insert watchpoint.  We don't automatically delete
1128
     such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1129
     is different from out-of-scope watchpoint.  */
1130
  if ( !target_has_execution)
1131
    {
1132
      /* Without execution, memory can't change.  No use to try and
1133
         set watchpoint locations.  The watchpoint will be reset when
1134
         the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set.  */
1135
    }
1136
  else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1137
    {
1138
      struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1139
      struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1140
 
1141
      fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1142
 
1143
      /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set.  The meaning of
1144
         b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1145
         it only if we reported that last value to user.  As it
1146
         happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.  */
1147
      if (!b->val_valid)
1148
        {
1149
          b->val = v;
1150
          b->val_valid = 1;
1151
        }
1152
 
1153
        /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or an
1154
           ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and free
1155
           hardware slots.  REPARSE is set when the inferior is started.  */
1156
        if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1157
            && reparse)
1158
          {
1159
            int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1160
 
1161
            /* We need to determine how many resources are already used
1162
               for all other hardware watchpoints to see if we still have
1163
               enough resources to also fit this watchpoint in as well.
1164
               To avoid the hw_watchpoint_used_count call below from counting
1165
               this watchpoint, make sure that it is marked as a software
1166
               watchpoint.  */
1167
            b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1168
            i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1169
                                          &other_type_used);
1170
            mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1171
 
1172
            if (!mem_cnt)
1173
              b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1174
            else
1175
              {
1176
                int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1177
                  (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1178
                if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1179
                  b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1180
                else
1181
                  b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1182
              }
1183
          }
1184
 
1185
      frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1186
 
1187
      /* Look at each value on the value chain.  */
1188
      for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1189
        {
1190
          /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1191
             its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1192
             must watch it.  If the first value returned is
1193
             still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1194
             watch it anyway in case it becomes readable.  */
1195
          if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1196
              && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1197
            {
1198
              struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1199
 
1200
              /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1201
                 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1202
                 appear in the middle of some value chain.  */
1203
              if (v == result
1204
                  || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1205
                      && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1206
                {
1207
                  CORE_ADDR addr;
1208
                  int len, type;
1209
                  struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1210
 
1211
                  addr = value_address (v);
1212
                  len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1213
                  type = hw_write;
1214
                  if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1215
                    type = hw_read;
1216
                  else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1217
                    type = hw_access;
1218
 
1219
                  loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1220
                  for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1221
                    ;
1222
                  *tmp = loc;
1223
                  loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1224
 
1225
                  loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1226
                  loc->address = addr;
1227
                  loc->length = len;
1228
                  loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1229
                }
1230
            }
1231
 
1232
          next = value_next (v);
1233
          if (v != b->val)
1234
            value_free (v);
1235
        }
1236
 
1237
      /* We just regenerated the list of breakpoint locations.
1238
         The new location does not have its condition field set to anything
1239
         and therefore, we must always reparse the cond_string, independently
1240
         of the value of the reparse flag.  */
1241
      if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1242
        {
1243
          char *s = b->cond_string;
1244
          b->loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1245
        }
1246
    }
1247
  else if (!within_current_scope)
1248
    {
1249
      printf_filtered (_("\
1250
Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block \n\
1251
in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1252
                       b->number);
1253
      if (b->related_breakpoint)
1254
        b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1255
      b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1256
    }
1257
 
1258
  /* Restore the selected frame.  */
1259
  if (frame_saved)
1260
    select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1261
}
1262
 
1263
 
1264
/* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1265
   inserted in the inferior.  */
1266
static int
1267
should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bpt)
1268
{
1269
  if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner))
1270
    return 0;
1271
 
1272
  if (bpt->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1273
    return 0;
1274
 
1275
  if (!bpt->enabled || bpt->shlib_disabled || bpt->duplicate)
1276
    return 0;
1277
 
1278
  /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1279
     vfork, and have detached from the child.  The child is running
1280
     free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1281
     OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1282
     that the vfork is done).  Until the child is done with the shared
1283
     memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1284
     the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints.  Since
1285
     the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint.  */
1286
  if (bpt->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1287
    return 0;
1288
 
1289
  /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1290
     not by us.  */
1291
  if (tracepoint_type (bpt->owner))
1292
    return 0;
1293
 
1294
  return 1;
1295
}
1296
 
1297
/* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type.  BPT is the breakpoint.
1298
   Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and DISABLED_BREAKS,
1299
   and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1300
 
1301
   NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an object-style
1302
   method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type.  */
1303
static int
1304
insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bpt,
1305
                    struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1306
                    int *disabled_breaks,
1307
                    int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1308
{
1309
  int val = 0;
1310
 
1311
  if (!should_be_inserted (bpt) || bpt->inserted)
1312
    return 0;
1313
 
1314
  /* Initialize the target-specific information.  */
1315
  memset (&bpt->target_info, 0, sizeof (bpt->target_info));
1316
  bpt->target_info.placed_address = bpt->address;
1317
  bpt->target_info.placed_address_space = bpt->pspace->aspace;
1318
 
1319
  if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1320
      || bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1321
    {
1322
      if (bpt->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1323
        {
1324
          /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1325
             is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1326
             if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1327
             Two important cases are:
1328
             - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1329
             is readonly.  We change the type of the location to
1330
             hardware breakpoint.
1331
             - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.
1332
             This means we've previously made the location hardware one, but
1333
             then the memory map changed, so we undo.
1334
 
1335
             When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will
1336
             use location types we've just set here, the only possible
1337
             problem is that memory map has changed during running program,
1338
             but it's not going to work anyway with current gdb.  */
1339
          struct mem_region *mr
1340
            = lookup_mem_region (bpt->target_info.placed_address);
1341
 
1342
          if (mr)
1343
            {
1344
              if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1345
                {
1346
                  int changed = 0;
1347
                  enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1348
 
1349
                  if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1350
                    new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1351
                  else
1352
                    new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1353
 
1354
                  if (new_type != bpt->loc_type)
1355
                    {
1356
                      static int said = 0;
1357
                      bpt->loc_type = new_type;
1358
                      if (!said)
1359
                        {
1360
                          fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1361
Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1362
                          said = 1;
1363
                        }
1364
                    }
1365
                }
1366
              else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1367
                       && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1368
                warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1369
                         paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address));
1370
            }
1371
        }
1372
 
1373
      /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay.  */
1374
      if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1375
          || bpt->section == NULL
1376
          || !(section_is_overlay (bpt->section)))
1377
        {
1378
          /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint.  */
1379
 
1380
          if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1381
            val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1382
                                               &bpt->target_info);
1383
          else
1384
            val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1385
                                            &bpt->target_info);
1386
        }
1387
      else
1388
        {
1389
          /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1390
             Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA?  */
1391
          if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1392
            {
1393
              /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1394
                 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1395
                 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint.  */
1396
              if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1397
                warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1398
                         bpt->owner->number);
1399
              else
1400
                {
1401
                  CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bpt->address,
1402
                                                             bpt->section);
1403
                  /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA.  */
1404
                  bpt->overlay_target_info = bpt->target_info;
1405
                  bpt->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1406
                  val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1407
                                                  &bpt->overlay_target_info);
1408
                  if (val != 0)
1409
                    fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1410
                                        "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1411
                                        bpt->owner->number);
1412
                }
1413
            }
1414
          /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1415
          if (section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
1416
            {
1417
              /* Yes.  This overlay section is mapped into memory.  */
1418
              if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1419
                val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1420
                                                   &bpt->target_info);
1421
              else
1422
                val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1423
                                                &bpt->target_info);
1424
            }
1425
          else
1426
            {
1427
              /* No.  This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1428
                 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'.  */
1429
              return 0;
1430
            }
1431
        }
1432
 
1433
      if (val)
1434
        {
1435
          /* Can't set the breakpoint.  */
1436
          if (solib_name_from_address (bpt->pspace, bpt->address))
1437
            {
1438
              /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1439
              val = 0;
1440
              bpt->shlib_disabled = 1;
1441
              if (!*disabled_breaks)
1442
                {
1443
                  fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1444
                                      "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1445
                                      bpt->owner->number);
1446
                  fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1447
                                      "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1448
                }
1449
              *disabled_breaks = 1;
1450
              fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1451
                                  "breakpoint #%d\n", bpt->owner->number);
1452
            }
1453
          else
1454
            {
1455
              if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1456
                {
1457
                  *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1458
                  fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1459
                                      "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1460
                                      bpt->owner->number);
1461
                }
1462
              else
1463
                {
1464
                  fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1465
                                      "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1466
                                      bpt->owner->number);
1467
                  fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1468
                                    "Error accessing memory address ");
1469
                  fputs_filtered (paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address),
1470
                                  tmp_error_stream);
1471
                  fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1472
                                    safe_strerror (val));
1473
                }
1474
 
1475
            }
1476
        }
1477
      else
1478
        bpt->inserted = 1;
1479
 
1480
      return val;
1481
    }
1482
 
1483
  else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1484
           /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1485
              watchpoints.  It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1486
           && bpt->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1487
    {
1488
      val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1489
                                      bpt->length,
1490
                                      bpt->watchpoint_type);
1491
      bpt->inserted = (val != -1);
1492
    }
1493
 
1494
  else if (bpt->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1495
    {
1496
      struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1497
                                                bpt->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1498
      exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1499
                         bpt->owner->number);
1500
      if (e.reason < 0)
1501
        bpt->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1502
      else
1503
        bpt->inserted = 1;
1504
 
1505
      /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1506
         inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1507
         so just return success.  */
1508
      return 0;
1509
    }
1510
 
1511
  return 0;
1512
}
1513
 
1514
/* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1515
   deleted.  It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1516
   PSPACE anymore.  */
1517
 
1518
void
1519
breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1520
{
1521
  struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1522
  struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1523
 
1524
  /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space.  */
1525
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1526
    {
1527
      if (b->pspace == pspace)
1528
        delete_breakpoint (b);
1529
    }
1530
 
1531
  /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1532
     bound to PSPACE as well.  Remove those.  */
1533
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1534
    {
1535
      struct bp_location *tmp;
1536
 
1537
      if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1538
        {
1539
          if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1540
            loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1541
          else
1542
            for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1543
              if (tmp->next == loc)
1544
                {
1545
                  tmp->next = loc->next;
1546
                  break;
1547
                }
1548
        }
1549
    }
1550
 
1551
  /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1552
     removed locations above.  */
1553
  update_global_location_list (0);
1554
}
1555
 
1556
/* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1557
   Throws exception on any error.
1558
   A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1559
   again, so calling this function twice is safe.  */
1560
void
1561
insert_breakpoints (void)
1562
{
1563
  struct breakpoint *bpt;
1564
 
1565
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1566
    if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1567
      update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1568
 
1569
  update_global_location_list (1);
1570
 
1571
  /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1572
     always_inserted_mode is not enabled.  Explicitly insert them
1573
     now.  */
1574
  if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1575
    insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1576
}
1577
 
1578
/* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1579
   remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1580
   Both return zero if successful,
1581
   or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior.  */
1582
 
1583
static void
1584
insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1585
{
1586
  struct breakpoint *bpt;
1587
  struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1588
  int error = 0;
1589
  int val = 0;
1590
  int disabled_breaks = 0;
1591
  int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1592
 
1593
  struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1594
  struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1595
 
1596
  /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1597
     there was an error.  */
1598
  fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1599
 
1600
  save_current_space_and_thread ();
1601
 
1602
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1603
    {
1604
      struct thread_info *tp;
1605
      CORE_ADDR last_addr;
1606
 
1607
      if (!should_be_inserted (b) || b->inserted)
1608
        continue;
1609
 
1610
      /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if the
1611
         thread no longer exists.  */
1612
      if (b->owner->thread != -1
1613
          && !valid_thread_id (b->owner->thread))
1614
        continue;
1615
 
1616
      switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
1617
 
1618
      /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1619
         to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to.  In fact, even
1620
         if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1621
         insert breakpoints.  */
1622
      if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1623
          && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1624
        continue;
1625
 
1626
      val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1627
                                    &disabled_breaks,
1628
                                    &hw_breakpoint_error);
1629
      if (val)
1630
        error = val;
1631
    }
1632
 
1633
  /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint,
1634
     remove them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use.  */
1635
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1636
    {
1637
      int some_failed = 0;
1638
      struct bp_location *loc;
1639
 
1640
      if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1641
        continue;
1642
 
1643
      if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1644
        continue;
1645
 
1646
      if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1647
        continue;
1648
 
1649
      for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1650
        if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1651
          {
1652
            some_failed = 1;
1653
            break;
1654
          }
1655
      if (some_failed)
1656
        {
1657
          for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1658
            if (loc->inserted)
1659
              remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1660
 
1661
          hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1662
          fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1663
                              "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1664
                              bpt->number);
1665
          error = -1;
1666
        }
1667
    }
1668
 
1669
  if (error)
1670
    {
1671
      /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1672
         message about possibly exhausted resources.  */
1673
      if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1674
        {
1675
          fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1676
                              "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1677
You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1678
        }
1679
      target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1680
      error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1681
    }
1682
 
1683
  do_cleanups (cleanups);
1684
}
1685
 
1686
int
1687
remove_breakpoints (void)
1688
{
1689
  struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1690
  int val = 0;
1691
 
1692
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1693
  {
1694
    if (b->inserted)
1695
      val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1696
  }
1697
  return val;
1698
}
1699
 
1700
/* Remove breakpoints of process PID.  */
1701
 
1702
int
1703
remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
1704
{
1705
  struct bp_location *b, **b_tmp;
1706
  int val;
1707
  struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1708
 
1709
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, b_tmp)
1710
  {
1711
    if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1712
      continue;
1713
 
1714
    if (b->inserted)
1715
      {
1716
        val = remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1717
        if (val != 0)
1718
          return val;
1719
      }
1720
  }
1721
  return 0;
1722
}
1723
 
1724
int
1725
remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
1726
{
1727
  struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1728
  int val = 0;
1729
 
1730
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1731
  {
1732
    if (b->inserted && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
1733
      val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1734
  }
1735
  return val;
1736
}
1737
 
1738
int
1739
reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
1740
{
1741
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
1742
  struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1743
  int val;
1744
  struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1745
  int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
1746
  struct inferior *inf;
1747
  struct thread_info *tp;
1748
 
1749
  tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
1750
  if (tp == NULL)
1751
    return 1;
1752
 
1753
  inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1754
  old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1755
 
1756
  inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
1757
 
1758
  make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1759
 
1760
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1761
  {
1762
    if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1763
      continue;
1764
 
1765
    if (b->inserted)
1766
      {
1767
        b->inserted = 0;
1768
        val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1769
                                  &dummy1, &dummy2);
1770
        if (val != 0)
1771
          {
1772
            do_cleanups (old_chain);
1773
            return val;
1774
          }
1775
      }
1776
  }
1777
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
1778
  return 0;
1779
}
1780
 
1781
static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
1782
 
1783
static struct breakpoint *
1784
create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
1785
                            CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
1786
{
1787
  struct symtab_and_line sal;
1788
  struct breakpoint *b;
1789
 
1790
  init_sal (&sal);              /* initialize to zeroes */
1791
 
1792
  sal.pc = address;
1793
  sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
1794
  sal.pspace = current_program_space;
1795
 
1796
  b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
1797
  b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
1798
  b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
1799
 
1800
  return b;
1801
}
1802
 
1803
static void
1804
create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1805
{
1806
  struct objfile *objfile;
1807
 
1808
  ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1809
    {
1810
      struct breakpoint *b;
1811
      struct minimal_symbol *m;
1812
 
1813
      m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1814
      if (m == NULL)
1815
        continue;
1816
 
1817
      b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1818
                                      SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1819
                                      bp_overlay_event);
1820
      b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1821
 
1822
      if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
1823
        {
1824
          b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
1825
          overlay_events_enabled = 1;
1826
        }
1827
      else
1828
       {
1829
         b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1830
         overlay_events_enabled = 0;
1831
       }
1832
    }
1833
  update_global_location_list (1);
1834
}
1835
 
1836
static void
1837
create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1838
{
1839
  struct program_space *pspace;
1840
  struct objfile *objfile;
1841
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
1842
 
1843
  old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
1844
 
1845
  ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
1846
  ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1847
    {
1848
      struct breakpoint *b;
1849
      struct minimal_symbol *m;
1850
 
1851
      if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
1852
        continue;
1853
 
1854
      set_current_program_space (pspace);
1855
 
1856
      m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1857
      if (m == NULL)
1858
        continue;
1859
 
1860
      b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1861
                                      SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1862
                                      bp_longjmp_master);
1863
      b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1864
      b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1865
    }
1866
  update_global_location_list (1);
1867
 
1868
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
1869
}
1870
 
1871
void
1872
update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
1873
{
1874
  struct breakpoint *b;
1875
  struct breakpoint *temp;
1876
  struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
1877
 
1878
  /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists.  If the
1879
     INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
1880
     writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory.  The
1881
     "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
1882
     do that.  Instead, the target is responsible from marking
1883
     breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec.  We don't do that
1884
     here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
1885
     breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here.  */
1886
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
1887
    if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
1888
      gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
1889
 
1890
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
1891
  {
1892
    if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
1893
      continue;
1894
 
1895
    /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1896
    if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
1897
      {
1898
        delete_breakpoint (b);
1899
        continue;
1900
      }
1901
 
1902
    /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1903
    if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
1904
      {
1905
        delete_breakpoint (b);
1906
        continue;
1907
      }
1908
 
1909
    /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
1910
       as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints.  */
1911
    if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
1912
        || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
1913
      {
1914
        delete_breakpoint (b);
1915
        continue;
1916
      }
1917
 
1918
    /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
1919
    if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
1920
      {
1921
        delete_breakpoint (b);
1922
        continue;
1923
      }
1924
 
1925
    /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
1926
       after an exec.  */
1927
    if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume)
1928
      {
1929
        delete_breakpoint (b);
1930
        continue;
1931
      }
1932
 
1933
    if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
1934
      {
1935
        /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
1936
           do anything at this point.  In the future, if some of
1937
           the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
1938
           a new method, and call this method from here.  */
1939
        continue;
1940
      }
1941
 
1942
    /* bp_finish is a special case.  The only way we ought to be able
1943
       to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
1944
       caught a vfork, and then said "finish".  Ordinarily a finish just
1945
       carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
1946
       a temporary bp there and resuming.  But in this case, the finish
1947
       will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
1948
 
1949
       We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now.  But
1950
       we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
1951
       the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it.  There's a
1952
       chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
1953
       here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
1954
       gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
1955
       We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
1956
 
1957
       In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
1958
       it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
1959
       problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
1960
       let finish_command delete it.
1961
 
1962
       (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
1963
       momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
1964
       the inferior stopped.  So it doesn't matter that the bp's
1965
       address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
1966
       solib breakpoints.)  */
1967
 
1968
    if (b->type == bp_finish)
1969
      {
1970
        continue;
1971
      }
1972
 
1973
    /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
1974
       pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
1975
       a.out. */
1976
    if (b->addr_string == NULL)
1977
      {
1978
        delete_breakpoint (b);
1979
        continue;
1980
      }
1981
  }
1982
  /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints?  Re-create them here?  */
1983
  create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
1984
  create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
1985
  create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
1986
  create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
1987
  create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
1988
}
1989
 
1990
int
1991
detach_breakpoints (int pid)
1992
{
1993
  struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1994
  int val = 0;
1995
  struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1996
  struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
1997
 
1998
  if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
1999
    error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
2000
 
2001
  /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global.  */
2002
  inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
2003
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
2004
  {
2005
    if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
2006
      continue;
2007
 
2008
    if (b->inserted)
2009
      val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (b, mark_inserted);
2010
  }
2011
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
2012
  return val;
2013
}
2014
 
2015
/* Remove the breakpoint location B from the current address space.
2016
   Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2017
   When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2018
   do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2019
   *not* look at b->pspace->aspace here.  */
2020
 
2021
static int
2022
remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2023
{
2024
  int val;
2025
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
2026
 
2027
  if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2028
    /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed.  */
2029
    return 0;
2030
 
2031
  /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2032
     This should not ever happen.  */
2033
  gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2034
 
2035
  if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2036
      || b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2037
    {
2038
      /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2039
         trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2040
         bp_hardware_breakpoint.  */
2041
 
2042
      /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay.  */
2043
      if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2044
          || b->section == NULL
2045
          || !(section_is_overlay (b->section)))
2046
        {
2047
          /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint.  */
2048
 
2049
          if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2050
            val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2051
          else
2052
            val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2053
        }
2054
      else
2055
        {
2056
          /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2057
             Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA?  */
2058
          if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2059
              {
2060
                /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2061
                   should have set a breakpoint at the LMA.  Remove it.
2062
                */
2063
                /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2064
                   have already warned when we failed to insert it.  */
2065
                if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2066
                  target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2067
                                               &b->overlay_target_info);
2068
                else
2069
                  target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2070
                                            &b->overlay_target_info);
2071
              }
2072
          /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2073
             If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'.  */
2074
          if (b->inserted)
2075
            {
2076
              /* Yes -- remove it.  Previously we did not bother to
2077
                 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2078
                 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe.  We
2079
                 don't know what the overlay manager might do.  */
2080
              if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2081
                val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2082
                                                   &b->target_info);
2083
 
2084
              /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2085
                 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2086
                 wrong code with the saved shadow contents.  */
2087
              else if (section_is_mapped (b->section))
2088
                val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2089
                                                &b->target_info);
2090
              else
2091
                val = 0;
2092
            }
2093
          else
2094
            {
2095
              /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove.  No error.  */
2096
              val = 0;
2097
            }
2098
        }
2099
 
2100
      /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2101
         in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2102
         have not yet processed the shlib unload event.  */
2103
      if (val && solib_name_from_address (b->pspace, b->address))
2104
        val = 0;
2105
 
2106
      if (val)
2107
        return val;
2108
      b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2109
    }
2110
  else if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2111
    {
2112
      struct value *v;
2113
      struct value *n;
2114
 
2115
      b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2116
      val = target_remove_watchpoint (b->address, b->length,
2117
                                      b->watchpoint_type);
2118
 
2119
      /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here.  */
2120
      if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (b->inserted))
2121
        warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2122
                 b->owner->number);
2123
    }
2124
  else if (b->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2125
           && breakpoint_enabled (b->owner)
2126
           && !b->duplicate)
2127
    {
2128
      gdb_assert (b->owner->ops != NULL && b->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2129
 
2130
      val = b->owner->ops->remove (b->owner);
2131
      if (val)
2132
        return val;
2133
      b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2134
    }
2135
 
2136
  return 0;
2137
}
2138
 
2139
static int
2140
remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2141
{
2142
  int ret;
2143
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
2144
 
2145
  if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2146
    /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed.  */
2147
    return 0;
2148
 
2149
  /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2150
     This should not ever happen.  */
2151
  gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2152
 
2153
  old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2154
 
2155
  switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
2156
 
2157
  ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (b, is);
2158
 
2159
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
2160
  return ret;
2161
}
2162
 
2163
/* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints.  */
2164
 
2165
void
2166
mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2167
{
2168
  struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2169
 
2170
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2171
    if (bpt->pspace == current_program_space)
2172
      bpt->inserted = 0;
2173
}
2174
 
2175
/* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2176
   breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2177
 
2178
   Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2179
   between runs.
2180
 
2181
   Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2182
   generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2183
   init_wait_for_inferior). */
2184
 
2185
 
2186
 
2187
void
2188
breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2189
{
2190
  struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
2191
  struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2192
  int ix;
2193
  struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2194
 
2195
  /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2196
     nothing to do.  */
2197
  if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2198
    return;
2199
 
2200
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2201
  {
2202
    if (bpt->pspace == pspace
2203
        && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2204
      bpt->inserted = 0;
2205
  }
2206
 
2207
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2208
  {
2209
    if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2210
      continue;
2211
 
2212
    switch (b->type)
2213
      {
2214
      case bp_call_dummy:
2215
      case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2216
 
2217
        /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2218
           cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better
2219
           get rid of it.
2220
 
2221
           Also get rid of scope breakpoints.  */
2222
        delete_breakpoint (b);
2223
        break;
2224
 
2225
      case bp_watchpoint:
2226
      case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2227
      case bp_read_watchpoint:
2228
      case bp_access_watchpoint:
2229
 
2230
        /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions.  */
2231
        if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2232
          delete_breakpoint (b);
2233
        else if (context == inf_starting)
2234
          {
2235
            /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value
2236
               in insert_breakpoints.  */
2237
            if (b->val)
2238
              value_free (b->val);
2239
            b->val = NULL;
2240
            b->val_valid = 0;
2241
          }
2242
        break;
2243
      default:
2244
        break;
2245
      }
2246
  }
2247
 
2248
  /* Get rid of the moribund locations.  */
2249
  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bpt); ++ix)
2250
    free_bp_location (bpt);
2251
  VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2252
}
2253
 
2254
/* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2255
   target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2256
   we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2257
   match, not program space.  */
2258
 
2259
/* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2260
   exists at PC.  It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2261
   ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2262
   permanent breakpoint.
2263
   - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2264
     actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2265
   - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2266
     need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2267
     the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint.  */
2268
 
2269
enum breakpoint_here
2270
breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2271
{
2272
  struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2273
  int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2274
 
2275
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2276
    {
2277
      if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2278
          && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2279
        continue;
2280
 
2281
      if ((breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2282
           || bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2283
          && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2284
                                       aspace, pc))
2285
        {
2286
          if (overlay_debugging
2287
              && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2288
              && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2289
            continue;           /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2290
          else if (bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2291
            return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2292
          else
2293
            any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2294
        }
2295
    }
2296
 
2297
  return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2298
}
2299
 
2300
/* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC.  */
2301
 
2302
int
2303
moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2304
{
2305
  struct bp_location *loc;
2306
  int ix;
2307
 
2308
  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2309
    if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2310
                                  aspace,  pc))
2311
      return 1;
2312
 
2313
  return 0;
2314
}
2315
 
2316
/* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2317
   inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array mechanism.
2318
   This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which are
2319
   inserted and removed using direct target manipulation.  */
2320
 
2321
int
2322
regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2323
{
2324
  struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2325
 
2326
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2327
    {
2328
      if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2329
          && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2330
        continue;
2331
 
2332
      if (bpt->inserted
2333
          && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2334
                                       aspace, pc))
2335
        {
2336
          if (overlay_debugging
2337
              && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2338
              && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2339
            continue;           /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2340
          else
2341
            return 1;
2342
        }
2343
    }
2344
  return 0;
2345
}
2346
 
2347
/* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2348
   or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC.  */
2349
 
2350
int
2351
breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2352
{
2353
  if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2354
    return 1;
2355
 
2356
  if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2357
    return 1;
2358
 
2359
  return 0;
2360
}
2361
 
2362
/* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2363
   inserted at PC.  */
2364
 
2365
int
2366
software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2367
{
2368
  struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2369
  int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2370
 
2371
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2372
    {
2373
      if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2374
        continue;
2375
 
2376
      if (bpt->inserted
2377
          && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2378
                                       aspace, pc))
2379
        {
2380
          if (overlay_debugging
2381
              && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2382
              && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2383
            continue;           /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2384
          else
2385
            return 1;
2386
        }
2387
    }
2388
 
2389
  /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints.  */
2390
  if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2391
    return 1;
2392
 
2393
  return 0;
2394
}
2395
 
2396
int
2397
hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2398
                                       CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2399
{
2400
  struct breakpoint *bpt;
2401
 
2402
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2403
    {
2404
      struct bp_location *loc;
2405
 
2406
      if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2407
          && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2408
        continue;
2409
 
2410
      if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2411
        continue;
2412
 
2413
      for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2414
        if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2415
          {
2416
            CORE_ADDR l, h;
2417
 
2418
            /* Check for intersection.  */
2419
            l = max (loc->address, addr);
2420
            h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2421
            if (l < h)
2422
              return 1;
2423
          }
2424
    }
2425
  return 0;
2426
}
2427
 
2428
/* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2429
   PC is valid for process/thread PTID.  */
2430
 
2431
int
2432
breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2433
                         ptid_t ptid)
2434
{
2435
  struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2436
  /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily.  */
2437
  int thread = -1;
2438
  int task = 0;
2439
 
2440
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2441
    {
2442
      if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2443
          && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2444
        continue;
2445
 
2446
      if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2447
          && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2448
        continue;
2449
 
2450
      if (!breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2451
                                     aspace, pc))
2452
        continue;
2453
 
2454
      if (bpt->owner->thread != -1)
2455
        {
2456
          /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint.  Check that ptid
2457
             matches that thread.  If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2458
             it is now time to do so.  */
2459
          if (thread == -1)
2460
            thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2461
          if (bpt->owner->thread != thread)
2462
            continue;
2463
        }
2464
 
2465
      if (bpt->owner->task != 0)
2466
        {
2467
          /* This is a task-specific breakpoint.  Check that ptid
2468
             matches that task.  If task hasn't been computed yet,
2469
             it is now time to do so.  */
2470
          if (task == 0)
2471
            task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2472
          if (bpt->owner->task != task)
2473
            continue;
2474
        }
2475
 
2476
      if (overlay_debugging
2477
          && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2478
          && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2479
        continue;           /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2480
 
2481
      return 1;
2482
    }
2483
 
2484
  return 0;
2485
}
2486
 
2487
 
2488
/* bpstat stuff.  External routines' interfaces are documented
2489
   in breakpoint.h.  */
2490
 
2491
int
2492
ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2493
{
2494
  return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2495
}
2496
 
2497
void
2498
bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2499
{
2500
  if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2501
    value_free (bs->old_val);
2502
  free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2503
  xfree (bs);
2504
}
2505
 
2506
/* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2507
   Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat.  */
2508
 
2509
void
2510
bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2511
{
2512
  bpstat p;
2513
  bpstat q;
2514
 
2515
  if (bsp == 0)
2516
    return;
2517
  p = *bsp;
2518
  while (p != NULL)
2519
    {
2520
      q = p->next;
2521
      bpstat_free (p);
2522
      p = q;
2523
    }
2524
  *bsp = NULL;
2525
}
2526
 
2527
/* Return a copy of a bpstat.  Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2528
   is part of the bpstat is copied as well.  */
2529
 
2530
bpstat
2531
bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2532
{
2533
  bpstat p = NULL;
2534
  bpstat tmp;
2535
  bpstat retval = NULL;
2536
 
2537
  if (bs == NULL)
2538
    return bs;
2539
 
2540
  for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2541
    {
2542
      tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2543
      memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2544
      if (bs->commands != NULL)
2545
        tmp->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
2546
      if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2547
        {
2548
          tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2549
          release_value (tmp->old_val);
2550
        }
2551
 
2552
      if (p == NULL)
2553
        /* This is the first thing in the chain.  */
2554
        retval = tmp;
2555
      else
2556
        p->next = tmp;
2557
      p = tmp;
2558
    }
2559
  p->next = NULL;
2560
  return retval;
2561
}
2562
 
2563
/* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint */
2564
 
2565
bpstat
2566
bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
2567
{
2568
  if (bsp == NULL)
2569
    return NULL;
2570
 
2571
  for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2572
    {
2573
      if (bsp->breakpoint_at && bsp->breakpoint_at->owner == breakpoint)
2574
        return bsp;
2575
    }
2576
  return NULL;
2577
}
2578
 
2579
/* Find a step_resume breakpoint associated with this bpstat.
2580
   (If there are multiple step_resume bp's on the list, this function
2581
   will arbitrarily pick one.)
2582
 
2583
   It is an error to use this function if BPSTAT doesn't contain a
2584
   step_resume breakpoint.
2585
 
2586
   See wait_for_inferior's use of this function.  */
2587
struct breakpoint *
2588
bpstat_find_step_resume_breakpoint (bpstat bsp)
2589
{
2590
  int current_thread;
2591
 
2592
  gdb_assert (bsp != NULL);
2593
 
2594
  current_thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
2595
 
2596
  for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2597
    {
2598
      if ((bsp->breakpoint_at != NULL)
2599
          && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->type == bp_step_resume)
2600
          && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == current_thread
2601
              || bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == -1))
2602
        return bsp->breakpoint_at->owner;
2603
    }
2604
 
2605
  internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("No step_resume breakpoint found."));
2606
}
2607
 
2608
 
2609
/* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are stopped
2610
   at.  *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the remaining
2611
   breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be good for
2612
   anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
2613
   Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
2614
   Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
2615
   we set it.
2616
   Return 1 otherwise.  */
2617
 
2618
int
2619
bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
2620
{
2621
  struct breakpoint *b;
2622
 
2623
  if ((*bsp) == NULL)
2624
    return 0;                    /* No more breakpoint values */
2625
 
2626
  /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that
2627
     correspond to a single breakpoint -- otherwise,
2628
     this function might return the same number more
2629
     than once and this will look ugly.  */
2630
  b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at ? (*bsp)->breakpoint_at->owner : NULL;
2631
  *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
2632
  if (b == NULL)
2633
    return -1;                  /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
2634
 
2635
  *num = b->number;             /* We have its number */
2636
  return 1;
2637
}
2638
 
2639
/* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed.  */
2640
 
2641
void
2642
bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
2643
{
2644
  for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2645
    {
2646
      free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2647
      if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2648
        {
2649
          value_free (bs->old_val);
2650
          bs->old_val = NULL;
2651
        }
2652
    }
2653
}
2654
 
2655
/* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior.  */
2656
 
2657
static void
2658
breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
2659
{
2660
  if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2661
    {
2662
      struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
2663
 
2664
      /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
2665
         interrupt the command list.  When the call finishes
2666
         successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
2667
         breakpoint as if nothing happened.  */
2668
      if (tp->in_infcall)
2669
        return;
2670
    }
2671
 
2672
  breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
2673
}
2674
 
2675
/* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint command */
2676
static void
2677
cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
2678
{
2679
  executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
2680
}
2681
 
2682
/* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at this
2683
   location.  Any of these commands could cause the process to proceed
2684
   beyond this point, etc.  We look out for such changes by checking
2685
   the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
2686
 
2687
   Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior.  In that
2688
   case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
2689
   bpstat of the current thread.  */
2690
 
2691
static int
2692
bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
2693
{
2694
  bpstat bs;
2695
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
2696
  int again = 0;
2697
 
2698
  /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
2699
     in bs->commands.  */
2700
  if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
2701
    return 0;
2702
 
2703
  executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
2704
  old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
2705
 
2706
  /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
2707
  bs = *bsp;
2708
 
2709
  breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
2710
  for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2711
    {
2712
      struct command_line *cmd;
2713
      struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
2714
 
2715
      /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
2716
 
2717
         The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
2718
         'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
2719
         frees stop_bpstat's command tree.  To make sure this doesn't
2720
         free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
2721
         take ownership of the tree ourselves.  Since a given bpstat's
2722
         commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
2723
         can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
2724
         the tree when we're done.  */
2725
      cmd = bs->commands;
2726
      bs->commands = 0;
2727
      this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_free_command_lines (&cmd);
2728
 
2729
      while (cmd != NULL)
2730
        {
2731
          execute_control_command (cmd);
2732
 
2733
          if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2734
            break;
2735
          else
2736
            cmd = cmd->next;
2737
        }
2738
 
2739
      /* We can free this command tree now.  */
2740
      do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
2741
 
2742
      if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2743
        {
2744
          if (target_can_async_p ())
2745
            /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
2746
               running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
2747
               us to do here -- just return to the event loop.  */
2748
            ;
2749
          else
2750
            /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
2751
               we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
2752
               Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
2753
               execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
2754
               only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
2755
               involved in execution of breakpoint commands.  So, we
2756
               can now execute breakpoint commands.  It should be
2757
               noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
2758
               not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
2759
               invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
2760
               command, and can easily blow up GDB stack.  Instead, we
2761
               return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
2762
               with the new stop_bpstat.  */
2763
            again = 1;
2764
          break;
2765
        }
2766
    }
2767
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
2768
  return again;
2769
}
2770
 
2771
void
2772
bpstat_do_actions (void)
2773
{
2774
  /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at.  */
2775
  while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
2776
         && target_has_execution
2777
         && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
2778
         && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
2779
    /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
2780
       and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
2781
       keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
2782
       indicate the inferior was not resumed.  */
2783
    if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->stop_bpstat))
2784
      break;
2785
}
2786
 
2787
/* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint.  */
2788
 
2789
static void
2790
watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
2791
{
2792
  if (val == NULL)
2793
    fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
2794
  else
2795
    {
2796
      struct value_print_options opts;
2797
      get_user_print_options (&opts);
2798
      value_print (val, stream, &opts);
2799
    }
2800
}
2801
 
2802
/* This is the normal print function for a bpstat.  In the future,
2803
   much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
2804
   by having it set different print_it values.
2805
 
2806
   Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called.  It loops
2807
   through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
2808
   print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
2809
   print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
2810
   bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
2811
 
2812
   Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
2813
   and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
2814
   PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
2815
   don't print anything else.
2816
   PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
2817
   that something to be followed by a location.
2818
   PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
2819
   that something to be followed by a location.
2820
   PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
2821
   analysis.  */
2822
 
2823
static enum print_stop_action
2824
print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
2825
{
2826
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
2827
  struct breakpoint *b;
2828
  const struct bp_location *bl;
2829
  struct ui_stream *stb;
2830
  int bp_temp = 0;
2831
  enum print_stop_action result;
2832
 
2833
  /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
2834
     which has since been deleted.  */
2835
  if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
2836
    return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2837
  bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
2838
  b = bl->owner;
2839
 
2840
  stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
2841
  old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
2842
 
2843
  switch (b->type)
2844
    {
2845
    case bp_breakpoint:
2846
    case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
2847
      bp_temp = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del;
2848
      if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
2849
        breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
2850
                                       bl->address,
2851
                                       b->number, 1);
2852
      annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
2853
      if (bp_temp)
2854
        ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
2855
      else
2856
        ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
2857
      if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2858
        {
2859
          ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
2860
                          async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
2861
          ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
2862
        }
2863
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
2864
      ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
2865
      result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
2866
      break;
2867
 
2868
    case bp_shlib_event:
2869
      /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
2870
         variable?  (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
2871
         to shlib event" message.) */
2872
      printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
2873
      result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2874
      break;
2875
 
2876
    case bp_thread_event:
2877
      /* Not sure how we will get here.
2878
         GDB should not stop for these breakpoints.  */
2879
      printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2880
      result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2881
      break;
2882
 
2883
    case bp_overlay_event:
2884
      /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
2885
      printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2886
      result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2887
      break;
2888
 
2889
    case bp_longjmp_master:
2890
      /* These should never be enabled.  */
2891
      printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2892
      result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2893
      break;
2894
 
2895
    case bp_watchpoint:
2896
    case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2897
      annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2898
      if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2899
        ui_out_field_string
2900
          (uiout, "reason",
2901
           async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2902
      mention (b);
2903
      make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2904
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2905
      watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2906
      ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2907
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2908
      watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2909
      ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2910
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2911
      /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered.  */
2912
      result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2913
      break;
2914
 
2915
    case bp_read_watchpoint:
2916
      if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2917
        ui_out_field_string
2918
          (uiout, "reason",
2919
           async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2920
      mention (b);
2921
      make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2922
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2923
      watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2924
      ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
2925
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2926
      result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2927
      break;
2928
 
2929
    case bp_access_watchpoint:
2930
      if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2931
        {
2932
          annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2933
          if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2934
            ui_out_field_string
2935
              (uiout, "reason",
2936
               async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2937
          mention (b);
2938
          make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2939
          ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2940
          watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2941
          ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2942
          ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2943
        }
2944
      else
2945
        {
2946
          mention (b);
2947
          if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2948
            ui_out_field_string
2949
              (uiout, "reason",
2950
               async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2951
          make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2952
          ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2953
        }
2954
      watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2955
      ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2956
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2957
      result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2958
      break;
2959
 
2960
    /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
2961
       here. */
2962
 
2963
    case bp_finish:
2964
      if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2965
        ui_out_field_string
2966
          (uiout, "reason",
2967
           async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
2968
      result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2969
      break;
2970
 
2971
    case bp_until:
2972
      if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2973
        ui_out_field_string
2974
          (uiout, "reason",
2975
           async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
2976
      result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2977
      break;
2978
 
2979
    case bp_none:
2980
    case bp_longjmp:
2981
    case bp_longjmp_resume:
2982
    case bp_step_resume:
2983
    case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2984
    case bp_call_dummy:
2985
    case bp_tracepoint:
2986
    case bp_fast_tracepoint:
2987
    case bp_jit_event:
2988
    default:
2989
      result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2990
      break;
2991
    }
2992
 
2993
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
2994
  return result;
2995
}
2996
 
2997
/* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
2998
   stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
2999
   'print_it' in the bpstat structure.  Under some circumstances we
3000
   may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
3001
   normal_stop(). */
3002
 
3003
static enum print_stop_action
3004
print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
3005
{
3006
  switch (bs->print_it)
3007
    {
3008
    case print_it_noop:
3009
      /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
3010
      return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3011
      break;
3012
 
3013
    case print_it_done:
3014
      /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3015
         relevant messages. */
3016
      return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3017
      break;
3018
 
3019
    case print_it_normal:
3020
      {
3021
        const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3022
        struct breakpoint *b = bl ? bl->owner : NULL;
3023
 
3024
        /* Normal case.  Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3025
           print_it_typical.  */
3026
        /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here?  */
3027
        if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3028
          return b->ops->print_it (b);
3029
        else
3030
          return print_it_typical (bs);
3031
      }
3032
        break;
3033
 
3034
    default:
3035
      internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3036
                      _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3037
      break;
3038
    }
3039
}
3040
 
3041
/* Print a message indicating what happened.  This is called from
3042
   normal_stop().  The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3043
   list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop.  This
3044
   routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3045
   about reasons for stopping.  This will print (for example) the
3046
   "Breakpoint n," part of the output.  The return value of this
3047
   routine is one of:
3048
 
3049
   PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing
3050
   PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3051
   code to print the location. An example is
3052
   "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3053
   the location.
3054
   PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3055
   to also print the location part of the message.
3056
   An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3057
   don't require a location appended to the end.
3058
   PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3059
   further info to be printed.*/
3060
 
3061
enum print_stop_action
3062
bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3063
{
3064
  int val;
3065
 
3066
  /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3067
     (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3068
     That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3069
     with respect to bpstat_explains_signal).  */
3070
  for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3071
    {
3072
      val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3073
      if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3074
          || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3075
          || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3076
        return val;
3077
    }
3078
 
3079
  /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3080
     with and nothing was printed. */
3081
  return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3082
}
3083
 
3084
/* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
3085
   This is used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3086
   The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to char * to
3087
   make it pass through catch_errors.  */
3088
 
3089
static int
3090
breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3091
{
3092
  struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3093
  int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3094
  value_free_to_mark (mark);
3095
  return i;
3096
}
3097
 
3098
/* Allocate a new bpstat and chain it to the current one.  */
3099
 
3100
static bpstat
3101
bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *bl, bpstat cbs /* Current "bs" value */ )
3102
{
3103
  bpstat bs;
3104
 
3105
  bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3106
  cbs->next = bs;
3107
  bs->breakpoint_at = bl;
3108
  /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands.  */
3109
  bs->commands = NULL;
3110
  bs->old_val = NULL;
3111
  bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3112
  return bs;
3113
}
3114
 
3115
/* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS.  Check if any hardware
3116
   watchpoints have triggered, according to the target.  */
3117
 
3118
int
3119
watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3120
{
3121
  int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3122
  CORE_ADDR addr;
3123
  struct breakpoint *b;
3124
 
3125
  if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3126
    {
3127
      /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint.  Mark all watchpoints
3128
         as not triggered.  */
3129
      ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3130
        if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3131
            || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3132
            || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3133
          b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3134
 
3135
      return 0;
3136
    }
3137
 
3138
  if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3139
    {
3140
      /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3141
         Mark all watchpoints as unknown.  */
3142
      ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3143
        if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3144
            || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3145
            || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3146
          b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3147
 
3148
      return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3149
    }
3150
 
3151
  /* The target could report the data address.  Mark watchpoints
3152
     affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3153
     triggered.  */
3154
 
3155
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3156
    if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3157
        || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3158
        || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3159
      {
3160
        struct bp_location *loc;
3161
        struct value *v;
3162
 
3163
        b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3164
        for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3165
          /* Exact match not required.  Within range is
3166
             sufficient.  */
3167
          if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3168
                                                   addr, loc->address,
3169
                                                   loc->length))
3170
            {
3171
              b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3172
              break;
3173
            }
3174
      }
3175
 
3176
  return 1;
3177
}
3178
 
3179
/* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3180
   because of check_errors).  */
3181
/* The watchpoint has been deleted.  */
3182
#define WP_DELETED 1
3183
/* The value has changed.  */
3184
#define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3185
/* The value has not changed.  */
3186
#define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3187
 
3188
#define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3189
#define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3190
 
3191
/* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value changed.
3192
 
3193
   P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
3194
   in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors.  */
3195
 
3196
static int
3197
watchpoint_check (void *p)
3198
{
3199
  bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3200
  struct breakpoint *b;
3201
  struct frame_info *fr;
3202
  int within_current_scope;
3203
 
3204
  b = bs->breakpoint_at->owner;
3205
 
3206
  /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3207
     watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3208
     that was used to create the watchpoint.  */
3209
  if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3210
    return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3211
 
3212
  if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3213
    within_current_scope = 1;
3214
  else
3215
    {
3216
      struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3217
      struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3218
      CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3219
 
3220
      /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're still
3221
         in the function but the stack frame has already been invalidated.
3222
         Since we can't rely on the values of local variables after the
3223
         stack has been destroyed, we are treating the watchpoint in that
3224
         state as `not changed' without further checking.  Don't mark
3225
         watchpoints as changed if the current frame is in an epilogue -
3226
         even if they are in some other frame, our view of the stack
3227
         is likely to be wrong and frame_find_by_id could error out.  */
3228
      if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3229
        return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3230
 
3231
      fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3232
      within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3233
 
3234
      /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3235
         returned a frame that can't describe this variable.  */
3236
      if (within_current_scope)
3237
        {
3238
          struct symbol *function;
3239
 
3240
          function = get_frame_function (fr);
3241
          if (function == NULL
3242
              || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3243
                                SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3244
            within_current_scope = 0;
3245
        }
3246
 
3247
      if (within_current_scope)
3248
        /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3249
           in normal_stop.  So this call to select_frame won't affect
3250
           the user.  */
3251
        select_frame (fr);
3252
    }
3253
 
3254
  if (within_current_scope)
3255
    {
3256
      /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a
3257
         *long* time before we return to the command level and
3258
         call free_all_values.  We can't call free_all_values because
3259
         we might be in the middle of evaluating a function call.  */
3260
 
3261
      struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3262
      struct value *new_val;
3263
 
3264
      fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3265
 
3266
      /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because the latter
3267
         coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just the address of the
3268
         array instead of its contents.  This is not what we want.  */
3269
      if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3270
          || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
3271
        {
3272
          if (new_val != NULL)
3273
            {
3274
              release_value (new_val);
3275
              value_free_to_mark (mark);
3276
            }
3277
          bs->old_val = b->val;
3278
          b->val = new_val;
3279
          b->val_valid = 1;
3280
          /* We will stop here */
3281
          return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3282
        }
3283
      else
3284
        {
3285
          /* Nothing changed, don't do anything.  */
3286
          value_free_to_mark (mark);
3287
          /* We won't stop here */
3288
          return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3289
        }
3290
    }
3291
  else
3292
    {
3293
      /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3294
         if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3295
         we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3296
         garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3297
         garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3298
         So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3299
         watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3300
         the first value assigned).  */
3301
      /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3302
         in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3303
         will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3304
         information here. */
3305
      if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3306
        ui_out_field_string
3307
          (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3308
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3309
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3310
      ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3311
which its expression is valid.\n");
3312
 
3313
      if (b->related_breakpoint)
3314
        b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3315
      b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3316
 
3317
      return WP_DELETED;
3318
    }
3319
}
3320
 
3321
/* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3322
   breakpoint location BL.  This function does not check if we
3323
   should stop, only if BL explains the stop.   */
3324
static int
3325
bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3326
                       struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3327
{
3328
  struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3329
 
3330
  /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3331
     tracepoints.  */
3332
  if (tracepoint_type (b))
3333
    return 0;
3334
 
3335
  if (b->type != bp_watchpoint
3336
      && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
3337
      && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
3338
      && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint
3339
      && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3340
      && b->type != bp_catchpoint)      /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3341
    {
3342
      if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3343
                                     aspace, bp_addr))
3344
        return 0;
3345
      if (overlay_debugging             /* unmapped overlay section */
3346
          && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3347
          && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3348
        return 0;
3349
    }
3350
 
3351
  /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3352
     reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3353
     some data address).  Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3354
     in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3355
     been defined.  Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3356
     (did not match the data address).  */
3357
 
3358
  if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3359
       || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3360
       || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3361
      && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3362
    return 0;
3363
 
3364
  if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3365
    {
3366
      if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3367
        return 0;
3368
      if (overlay_debugging             /* unmapped overlay section */
3369
          && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3370
          && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3371
        return 0;
3372
    }
3373
 
3374
  if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3375
    {
3376
      gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3377
      if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3378
        return 0;
3379
    }
3380
 
3381
  return 1;
3382
}
3383
 
3384
/* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3385
   has actually changed, and we should stop.  If not, set BS->stop
3386
   to 0.  */
3387
static void
3388
bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3389
{
3390
  const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3391
  struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3392
 
3393
  if (b->type == bp_watchpoint
3394
      || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3395
      || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
3396
      || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3397
    {
3398
      CORE_ADDR addr;
3399
      struct value *v;
3400
      int must_check_value = 0;
3401
 
3402
      if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3403
        /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3404
           watched value.  */
3405
        must_check_value = 1;
3406
      else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3407
        /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3408
           and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3409
           this watchpoint.  */
3410
        must_check_value = 1;
3411
      else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3412
               && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3413
        /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3414
           not report the data address.  We must check the watchpoint's
3415
           value.  Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3416
           a data address, we can't figure it out.  */
3417
        must_check_value = 1;
3418
 
3419
      if (must_check_value)
3420
        {
3421
          char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3422
                                      b->number);
3423
          struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3424
          int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3425
                                RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3426
          do_cleanups (cleanups);
3427
          switch (e)
3428
            {
3429
            case WP_DELETED:
3430
              /* We've already printed what needs to be printed.  */
3431
              bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3432
              /* Stop.  */
3433
              break;
3434
            case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3435
              if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3436
                {
3437
                  /* Don't stop: read watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3438
                     the value has changed.  This is for targets
3439
                     which cannot set read-only watchpoints.  */
3440
                  bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3441
                  bs->stop = 0;
3442
                }
3443
              break;
3444
            case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3445
              if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3446
                  || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3447
                {
3448
                  /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3449
                     the value hasn't changed.  */
3450
                  bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3451
                  bs->stop = 0;
3452
                }
3453
              /* Stop.  */
3454
              break;
3455
            default:
3456
              /* Can't happen.  */
3457
            case 0:
3458
              /* Error from catch_errors.  */
3459
              printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3460
              if (b->related_breakpoint)
3461
                b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3462
              b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3463
              /* We've already printed what needs to be printed.  */
3464
              bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3465
              break;
3466
            }
3467
        }
3468
      else      /* must_check_value == 0 */
3469
        {
3470
          /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3471
             not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3472
             watchpoint triggered after all.  So don't print
3473
             anything for this watchpoint.  */
3474
          bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3475
          bs->stop = 0;
3476
        }
3477
    }
3478
}
3479
 
3480
 
3481
/* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3482
   of breakpoint referred to by BS.  If we should not stop for this
3483
   breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0.  */
3484
static void
3485
bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3486
{
3487
  int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3488
  const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3489
  struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3490
 
3491
  if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
3492
      && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
3493
    bs->stop = 0;
3494
  else if (bs->stop)
3495
    {
3496
      int value_is_zero = 0;
3497
 
3498
      /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
3499
         watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
3500
         out-of-scope event.  We'll get to the watchpoint next
3501
         iteration.  */
3502
      if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
3503
        b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3504
 
3505
      if (bl->cond && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
3506
        {
3507
          /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
3508
             be a long time before we return to the command level and
3509
             call free_all_values.  We can't call free_all_values
3510
             because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
3511
             function call.  */
3512
          struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3513
 
3514
          /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
3515
             the conditions will have the right context.  Because we
3516
             use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
3517
             variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
3518
             of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
3519
             call site.  */
3520
          select_frame (get_current_frame ());
3521
          value_is_zero
3522
            = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, (bl->cond),
3523
                            "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
3524
                            RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3525
          /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint # */
3526
          value_free_to_mark (mark);
3527
        }
3528
      if (bl->cond && value_is_zero)
3529
        {
3530
          bs->stop = 0;
3531
        }
3532
      else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
3533
        {
3534
          bs->stop = 0;
3535
        }
3536
      else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
3537
        {
3538
          b->ignore_count--;
3539
          annotate_ignore_count_change ();
3540
          bs->stop = 0;
3541
          /* Increase the hit count even though we don't
3542
             stop.  */
3543
          ++(b->hit_count);
3544
        }
3545
    }
3546
}
3547
 
3548
 
3549
/* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
3550
   BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
3551
 
3552
   Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
3553
   don't understand this stop.  Result is a chain of bpstat's such that:
3554
 
3555
   if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
3556
 
3557
   if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
3558
 
3559
   Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
3560
   watchpoint at which we have stopped.  (We may have stopped for
3561
   several reasons concurrently.)
3562
 
3563
   Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
3564
   commands, FIXME??? fields.  */
3565
 
3566
bpstat
3567
bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
3568
                    CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
3569
{
3570
  struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
3571
  struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3572
  struct bp_location *loc;
3573
  /* Root of the chain of bpstat's */
3574
  struct bpstats root_bs[1];
3575
  /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently.  */
3576
  bpstat bs = root_bs;
3577
  int ix;
3578
  int need_remove_insert;
3579
 
3580
  /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS iteration would break across
3581
     update_global_location_list possibly executed by
3582
     bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions's inferior call.  */
3583
 
3584
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3585
    {
3586
      if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3587
        continue;
3588
 
3589
      for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
3590
        {
3591
          /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first location.
3592
             The watchpoint_check function will work on entire expression,
3593
             not the individual locations.  For read watchopints, the
3594
             watchpoints_triggered function have checked all locations
3595
             already.  */
3596
          if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
3597
            break;
3598
 
3599
          if (bl->shlib_disabled)
3600
            continue;
3601
 
3602
          if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
3603
            continue;
3604
 
3605
          /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address matches */
3606
 
3607
          bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, bs);   /* Alloc a bpstat to explain stop */
3608
 
3609
          /* Assume we stop.  Should we find watchpoint that is not actually
3610
             triggered, or if condition of breakpoint is false, we'll reset
3611
             'stop' to 0.  */
3612
          bs->stop = 1;
3613
          bs->print = 1;
3614
 
3615
          bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
3616
          if (!bs->stop)
3617
            continue;
3618
 
3619
          if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3620
              || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
3621
            /* We do not stop for these.  */
3622
            bs->stop = 0;
3623
          else
3624
            bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
3625
 
3626
          if (bs->stop)
3627
            {
3628
              ++(b->hit_count);
3629
 
3630
              /* We will stop here */
3631
              if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
3632
                {
3633
                  if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3634
                    b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3635
                  update_global_location_list (0);
3636
                }
3637
              if (b->silent)
3638
                bs->print = 0;
3639
              bs->commands = b->commands;
3640
              if (bs->commands
3641
                  && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands->line) == 0
3642
                      || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q",
3643
                                                  bs->commands->line) == 0)))
3644
                {
3645
                  bs->commands = bs->commands->next;
3646
                  bs->print = 0;
3647
                }
3648
              bs->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
3649
            }
3650
 
3651
          /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or dont print.  */
3652
          if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
3653
            bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3654
        }
3655
    }
3656
 
3657
  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
3658
    {
3659
      if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
3660
                                    aspace, bp_addr))
3661
        {
3662
          bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, bs);
3663
          /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed.  */
3664
          bs->stop = 0;
3665
          bs->print = 0;
3666
          bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3667
        }
3668
    }
3669
 
3670
  bs->next = NULL;              /* Terminate the chain */
3671
 
3672
  /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
3673
     not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
3674
     watching may have.  Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
3675
     done later.  */
3676
  for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3677
    if (bs->stop)
3678
      break;
3679
 
3680
  need_remove_insert = 0;
3681
  if (bs == NULL)
3682
    for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3683
      if (!bs->stop
3684
          && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
3685
          && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner))
3686
        {
3687
          update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3688
          /* Updating watchpoints invalidates bs->breakpoint_at.
3689
             Prevent further code from trying to use it.  */
3690
          bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
3691
          need_remove_insert = 1;
3692
        }
3693
 
3694
  if (need_remove_insert)
3695
    update_global_location_list (1);
3696
 
3697
  return root_bs->next;
3698
}
3699
 
3700
/* Tell what to do about this bpstat.  */
3701
struct bpstat_what
3702
bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
3703
{
3704
  /* Classify each bpstat as one of the following.  */
3705
  enum class
3706
    {
3707
      /* This bpstat element has no effect on the main_action.  */
3708
      no_effect = 0,
3709
 
3710
      /* There was a watchpoint, stop but don't print.  */
3711
      wp_silent,
3712
 
3713
      /* There was a watchpoint, stop and print.  */
3714
      wp_noisy,
3715
 
3716
      /* There was a breakpoint but we're not stopping.  */
3717
      bp_nostop,
3718
 
3719
      /* There was a breakpoint, stop but don't print.  */
3720
      bp_silent,
3721
 
3722
      /* There was a breakpoint, stop and print.  */
3723
      bp_noisy,
3724
 
3725
      /* We hit the longjmp breakpoint.  */
3726
      long_jump,
3727
 
3728
      /* We hit the longjmp_resume breakpoint.  */
3729
      long_resume,
3730
 
3731
      /* We hit the step_resume breakpoint.  */
3732
      step_resume,
3733
 
3734
      /* We hit the shared library event breakpoint.  */
3735
      shlib_event,
3736
 
3737
      /* We hit the jit event breakpoint.  */
3738
      jit_event,
3739
 
3740
      /* This is just used to count how many enums there are.  */
3741
      class_last
3742
    };
3743
 
3744
  /* Here is the table which drives this routine.  So that we can
3745
     format it pretty, we define some abbreviations for the
3746
     enum bpstat_what codes.  */
3747
#define kc BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
3748
#define ss BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
3749
#define sn BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3750
#define sgl BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
3751
#define slr BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME
3752
#define clr BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME
3753
#define sr BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME
3754
#define shl BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_SHLIBS
3755
#define jit BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_JIT
3756
 
3757
/* "Can't happen."  Might want to print an error message.
3758
   abort() is not out of the question, but chances are GDB is just
3759
   a bit confused, not unusable.  */
3760
#define err BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3761
 
3762
  /* Given an old action and a class, come up with a new action.  */
3763
  /* One interesting property of this table is that wp_silent is the same
3764
     as bp_silent and wp_noisy is the same as bp_noisy.  That is because
3765
     after stopping, the check for whether to step over a breakpoint
3766
     (BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE type stuff) is handled in proceed() without
3767
     reference to how we stopped.  We retain separate wp_silent and
3768
     bp_silent codes in case we want to change that someday.
3769
 
3770
     Another possibly interesting property of this table is that
3771
     there's a partial ordering, priority-like, of the actions.  Once
3772
     you've decided that some action is appropriate, you'll never go
3773
     back and decide something of a lower priority is better.  The
3774
     ordering is:
3775
 
3776
     kc   < jit clr sgl shl slr sn sr ss
3777
     sgl  < jit shl slr sn sr ss
3778
     slr  < jit err shl sn sr ss
3779
     clr  < jit err shl sn sr ss
3780
     ss   < jit shl sn sr
3781
     sn   < jit shl sr
3782
     jit  < shl sr
3783
     shl  < sr
3784
     sr   <
3785
 
3786
     What I think this means is that we don't need a damned table
3787
     here.  If you just put the rows and columns in the right order,
3788
     it'd look awfully regular.  We could simply walk the bpstat list
3789
     and choose the highest priority action we find, with a little
3790
     logic to handle the 'err' cases.  */
3791
 
3792
  /* step_resume entries: a step resume breakpoint overrides another
3793
     breakpoint of signal handling (see comment in wait_for_inferior
3794
     at where we set the step_resume breakpoint).  */
3795
 
3796
  static const enum bpstat_what_main_action
3797
    table[(int) class_last][(int) BPSTAT_WHAT_LAST] =
3798
  {
3799
  /*                              old action */
3800
  /*               kc   ss   sn   sgl  slr  clr  sr  shl  jit */
3801
/* no_effect */   {kc,  ss,  sn,  sgl, slr, clr, sr, shl, jit},
3802
/* wp_silent */   {ss,  ss,  sn,  ss,  ss,  ss,  sr, shl, jit},
3803
/* wp_noisy */    {sn,  sn,  sn,  sn,  sn,  sn,  sr, shl, jit},
3804
/* bp_nostop */   {sgl, ss,  sn,  sgl, slr, slr, sr, shl, jit},
3805
/* bp_silent */   {ss,  ss,  sn,  ss,  ss,  ss,  sr, shl, jit},
3806
/* bp_noisy */    {sn,  sn,  sn,  sn,  sn,  sn,  sr, shl, jit},
3807
/* long_jump */   {slr, ss,  sn,  slr, slr, err, sr, shl, jit},
3808
/* long_resume */ {clr, ss,  sn,  err, err, err, sr, shl, jit},
3809
/* step_resume */ {sr,  sr,  sr,  sr,  sr,  sr,  sr, sr,  sr },
3810
/* shlib */       {shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, sr, shl, shl},
3811
/* jit_event */   {jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, sr, jit, jit}
3812
  };
3813
 
3814
#undef kc
3815
#undef ss
3816
#undef sn
3817
#undef sgl
3818
#undef slr
3819
#undef clr
3820
#undef err
3821
#undef sr
3822
#undef ts
3823
#undef shl
3824
#undef jit
3825
  enum bpstat_what_main_action current_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
3826
  struct bpstat_what retval;
3827
 
3828
  retval.call_dummy = 0;
3829
  for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3830
    {
3831
      enum class bs_class = no_effect;
3832
      if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
3833
        /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary breakpoint
3834
           which has since been deleted.  */
3835
        continue;
3836
      if (bs->breakpoint_at->owner == NULL)
3837
        bs_class = bp_nostop;
3838
      else
3839
      switch (bs->breakpoint_at->owner->type)
3840
        {
3841
        case bp_none:
3842
          continue;
3843
 
3844
        case bp_breakpoint:
3845
        case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
3846
        case bp_until:
3847
        case bp_finish:
3848
          if (bs->stop)
3849
            {
3850
              if (bs->print)
3851
                bs_class = bp_noisy;
3852
              else
3853
                bs_class = bp_silent;
3854
            }
3855
          else
3856
            bs_class = bp_nostop;
3857
          break;
3858
        case bp_watchpoint:
3859
        case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3860
        case bp_read_watchpoint:
3861
        case bp_access_watchpoint:
3862
          if (bs->stop)
3863
            {
3864
              if (bs->print)
3865
                bs_class = wp_noisy;
3866
              else
3867
                bs_class = wp_silent;
3868
            }
3869
          else
3870
            /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3871
               This requires no further action.  */
3872
            bs_class = no_effect;
3873
          break;
3874
        case bp_longjmp:
3875
          bs_class = long_jump;
3876
          break;
3877
        case bp_longjmp_resume:
3878
          bs_class = long_resume;
3879
          break;
3880
        case bp_step_resume:
3881
          if (bs->stop)
3882
            {
3883
              bs_class = step_resume;
3884
            }
3885
          else
3886
            /* It is for the wrong frame.  */
3887
            bs_class = bp_nostop;
3888
          break;
3889
        case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3890
          bs_class = bp_nostop;
3891
          break;
3892
        case bp_shlib_event:
3893
          bs_class = shlib_event;
3894
          break;
3895
        case bp_jit_event:
3896
          bs_class = jit_event;
3897
          break;
3898
        case bp_thread_event:
3899
        case bp_overlay_event:
3900
        case bp_longjmp_master:
3901
          bs_class = bp_nostop;
3902
          break;
3903
        case bp_catchpoint:
3904
          if (bs->stop)
3905
            {
3906
              if (bs->print)
3907
                bs_class = bp_noisy;
3908
              else
3909
                bs_class = bp_silent;
3910
            }
3911
          else
3912
            /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3913
               This requires no further action.  */
3914
            bs_class = no_effect;
3915
          break;
3916
        case bp_call_dummy:
3917
          /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
3918
             so infrun.c pops the dummy frame.  */
3919
          bs_class = bp_silent;
3920
          retval.call_dummy = 1;
3921
          break;
3922
        case bp_tracepoint:
3923
        case bp_fast_tracepoint:
3924
          /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
3925
             if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
3926
             out already.  */
3927
          internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3928
                          _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
3929
          break;
3930
        }
3931
      current_action = table[(int) bs_class][(int) current_action];
3932
    }
3933
  retval.main_action = current_action;
3934
  return retval;
3935
}
3936
 
3937
/* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
3938
   without hardware support).  This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
3939
   just to things like whether watchpoints are set.  */
3940
 
3941
int
3942
bpstat_should_step (void)
3943
{
3944
  struct breakpoint *b;
3945
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3946
    if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
3947
      return 1;
3948
  return 0;
3949
}
3950
 
3951
int
3952
bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
3953
{
3954
  for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3955
    if (bs->stop)
3956
      return 1;
3957
 
3958
  return 0;
3959
}
3960
 
3961
 
3962
 
3963
/* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations.  */
3964
 
3965
static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
3966
                                       struct bp_location *loc,
3967
                                       char *wrap_indent,
3968
                                       struct ui_stream *stb)
3969
{
3970
  struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3971
 
3972
  if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
3973
    loc = NULL;
3974
 
3975
  if (loc != NULL)
3976
    set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
3977
 
3978
  if (b->source_file && loc)
3979
    {
3980
      struct symbol *sym
3981
        = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
3982
      if (sym)
3983
        {
3984
          ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
3985
          ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
3986
                               SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
3987
          ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
3988
          ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
3989
        }
3990
      ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
3991
      ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
3992
 
3993
      if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3994
        {
3995
          struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
3996
          char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
3997
 
3998
          if (fullname)
3999
            ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
4000
        }
4001
 
4002
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
4003
    }
4004
  else if (loc)
4005
    {
4006
      print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb->stream,
4007
                              demangle, "");
4008
      ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
4009
    }
4010
  else
4011
    ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
4012
 
4013
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
4014
}
4015
 
4016
/* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
4017
static void
4018
print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4019
                               struct bp_location *loc,
4020
                               int loc_number,
4021
                               struct bp_location **last_loc,
4022
                               int print_address_bits,
4023
                               int allflag)
4024
{
4025
  struct command_line *l;
4026
  struct symbol *sym;
4027
  struct ep_type_description
4028
    {
4029
      enum bptype type;
4030
      char *description;
4031
    };
4032
  static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4033
  {
4034
    {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4035
    {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4036
    {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4037
    {bp_until, "until"},
4038
    {bp_finish, "finish"},
4039
    {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4040
    {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4041
    {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4042
    {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4043
    {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4044
    {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4045
    {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4046
    {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4047
    {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4048
    {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4049
    {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4050
    {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4051
    {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4052
    {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4053
    {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4054
    {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
4055
    {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4056
  };
4057
 
4058
  static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4059
  char wrap_indent[80];
4060
  struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4061
  struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4062
  struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4063
 
4064
  int header_of_multiple = 0;
4065
  int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4066
  struct value_print_options opts;
4067
 
4068
  get_user_print_options (&opts);
4069
 
4070
  gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4071
  /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning
4072
     treatment of breakpoints with single disabled
4073
     location.  */
4074
  if (loc == NULL
4075
      && (b->loc != NULL
4076
          && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4077
    header_of_multiple = 1;
4078
  if (loc == NULL)
4079
    loc = b->loc;
4080
 
4081
  annotate_record ();
4082
  bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4083
 
4084
  /* 1 */
4085
  annotate_field (0);
4086
  if (part_of_multiple)
4087
    {
4088
      char *formatted;
4089
      formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4090
      ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4091
      xfree (formatted);
4092
    }
4093
  else
4094
    {
4095
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4096
    }
4097
 
4098
  /* 2 */
4099
  annotate_field (1);
4100
  if (part_of_multiple)
4101
    ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4102
  else
4103
    {
4104
      if (((int) b->type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4105
          || ((int) b->type != bptypes[(int) b->type].type))
4106
        internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4107
                        _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4108
                        (int) b->type);
4109
      ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptypes[(int) b->type].description);
4110
    }
4111
 
4112
  /* 3 */
4113
  annotate_field (2);
4114
  if (part_of_multiple)
4115
    ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4116
  else
4117
    ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4118
 
4119
 
4120
  /* 4 */
4121
  annotate_field (3);
4122
  if (part_of_multiple)
4123
    ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4124
  else
4125
      ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4126
                        bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4127
  ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4128
 
4129
 
4130
  /* 5 and 6 */
4131
  strcpy (wrap_indent, "                           ");
4132
  if (opts.addressprint)
4133
    {
4134
      if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4135
        strcat (wrap_indent, "           ");
4136
      else
4137
        strcat (wrap_indent, "                   ");
4138
    }
4139
 
4140
  if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4141
    {
4142
      /* Although the print_one can possibly print
4143
         all locations,  calling it here is not likely
4144
         to get any nice result.  So, make sure there's
4145
         just one location.  */
4146
      gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4147
      b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4148
    }
4149
  else
4150
    switch (b->type)
4151
      {
4152
      case bp_none:
4153
        internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4154
                        _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4155
        break;
4156
 
4157
      case bp_watchpoint:
4158
      case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4159
      case bp_read_watchpoint:
4160
      case bp_access_watchpoint:
4161
        /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4162
           not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4163
           is relatively readable).  */
4164
        if (opts.addressprint)
4165
          ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4166
        annotate_field (5);
4167
        ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4168
        break;
4169
 
4170
      case bp_breakpoint:
4171
      case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4172
      case bp_until:
4173
      case bp_finish:
4174
      case bp_longjmp:
4175
      case bp_longjmp_resume:
4176
      case bp_step_resume:
4177
      case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4178
      case bp_call_dummy:
4179
      case bp_shlib_event:
4180
      case bp_thread_event:
4181
      case bp_overlay_event:
4182
      case bp_longjmp_master:
4183
      case bp_tracepoint:
4184
      case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4185
      case bp_jit_event:
4186
        if (opts.addressprint)
4187
          {
4188
            annotate_field (4);
4189
            if (header_of_multiple)
4190
              ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4191
            else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4192
              ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4193
            else
4194
              ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4195
                                      loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4196
          }
4197
        annotate_field (5);
4198
        if (!header_of_multiple)
4199
          print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4200
        if (b->loc)
4201
          *last_loc = b->loc;
4202
        break;
4203
      }
4204
 
4205
 
4206
  /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4207
     are several.  */
4208
  if (loc != NULL
4209
      && !header_of_multiple
4210
      && (allflag
4211
          || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4212
              && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4213
                  || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4214
              && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4215
    {
4216
      struct inferior *inf;
4217
      int first = 1;
4218
 
4219
      for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4220
        {
4221
          if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4222
            {
4223
              if (first)
4224
                {
4225
                  first = 0;
4226
                  ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4227
                }
4228
              else
4229
                ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4230
              ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4231
            }
4232
        }
4233
    }
4234
 
4235
  if (!part_of_multiple)
4236
    {
4237
      if (b->thread != -1)
4238
        {
4239
          /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4240
             "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4241
          ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4242
          ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4243
        }
4244
      else if (b->task != 0)
4245
        {
4246
          ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4247
          ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4248
        }
4249
    }
4250
 
4251
  ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4252
 
4253
  if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4254
    {
4255
      annotate_field (6);
4256
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4257
      /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4258
         the frame ID.  */
4259
      ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4260
                              b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4261
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4262
    }
4263
 
4264
  if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4265
    {
4266
      /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4267
         because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4268
         that we do not want to expose to the user.  */
4269
      annotate_field (7);
4270
      if (tracepoint_type (b))
4271
        ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4272
      else
4273
        ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4274
      ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4275
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4276
    }
4277
 
4278
  if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4279
    {
4280
      /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4281
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4282
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4283
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4284
    }
4285
 
4286
  if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4287
    {
4288
      /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4289
      if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4290
        ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4291
      else
4292
        ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4293
      ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4294
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4295
      if (b->hit_count == 1)
4296
        ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4297
      else
4298
        ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4299
    }
4300
 
4301
  /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is
4302
     mi. FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4303
  if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4304
    if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4305
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4306
 
4307
  if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4308
    {
4309
      annotate_field (8);
4310
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4311
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4312
      ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4313
    }
4314
 
4315
  l = b->commands;
4316
  if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4317
    {
4318
      struct cleanup *script_chain;
4319
 
4320
      annotate_field (9);
4321
      script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4322
      print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4323
      do_cleanups (script_chain);
4324
    }
4325
 
4326
  if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4327
    {
4328
      annotate_field (10);
4329
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4330
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4331
      ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4332
    }
4333
 
4334
  if (!part_of_multiple && b->step_count)
4335
    {
4336
      annotate_field (11);
4337
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstep count ");
4338
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "step", b->step_count);
4339
      ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4340
    }
4341
 
4342
  if (!part_of_multiple && b->actions)
4343
    {
4344
      struct action_line *action;
4345
      annotate_field (12);
4346
      for (action = b->actions; action; action = action->next)
4347
        {
4348
          ui_out_text (uiout, "      A\t");
4349
          ui_out_text (uiout, action->action);
4350
          ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4351
        }
4352
    }
4353
 
4354
  if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4355
    {
4356
      if (b->addr_string)
4357
        ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4358
      else if (b->exp_string)
4359
        ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4360
    }
4361
 
4362
  do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4363
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
4364
}
4365
 
4366
static void
4367
print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4368
                      struct bp_location **last_loc, int print_address_bits,
4369
                      int allflag)
4370
{
4371
  print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4372
                                 print_address_bits, allflag);
4373
 
4374
  /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4375
     it's already printed.  Otherwise, print individual
4376
     locations, if any.  */
4377
  if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4378
    {
4379
      /* If breakpoint has a single location that is
4380
         disabled, we print it as if it had
4381
         several locations, since otherwise it's hard to
4382
         represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4383
         situation.
4384
         Note that while hardware watchpoints have
4385
         several locations internally, that's no a property
4386
         exposed to user.  */
4387
      if (b->loc
4388
          && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4389
          && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4390
          && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4391
        {
4392
          struct bp_location *loc;
4393
          int n = 1;
4394
          for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4395
            print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4396
                                           print_address_bits, allflag);
4397
        }
4398
    }
4399
}
4400
 
4401
static int
4402
breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4403
{
4404
  int print_address_bits = 0;
4405
  struct bp_location *loc;
4406
 
4407
  for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4408
    {
4409
      int addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4410
      if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4411
        print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4412
    }
4413
 
4414
  return print_address_bits;
4415
}
4416
 
4417
struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4418
  {
4419
    int bnum;
4420
  };
4421
 
4422
static int
4423
do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4424
{
4425
  struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4426
  struct breakpoint *b;
4427
  struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4428
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4429
    {
4430
      if (args->bnum == b->number)
4431
        {
4432
          int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4433
          print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4434
          return GDB_RC_OK;
4435
        }
4436
    }
4437
  return GDB_RC_NONE;
4438
}
4439
 
4440
enum gdb_rc
4441
gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, char **error_message)
4442
{
4443
  struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4444
  args.bnum = bnum;
4445
  /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
4446
     an error. */
4447
  if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
4448
                                 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
4449
    return GDB_RC_FAIL;
4450
  else
4451
    return GDB_RC_OK;
4452
}
4453
 
4454
/* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
4455
   catchpoints, et.al.). */
4456
 
4457
static int
4458
user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
4459
{
4460
  return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
4461
          || b->type == bp_catchpoint
4462
          || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4463
          || tracepoint_type (b)
4464
          || b->type == bp_watchpoint
4465
          || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
4466
          || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
4467
          || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint);
4468
}
4469
 
4470
/* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
4471
   number BNUM.  If BNUM is -1 print all user settable breakpoints.
4472
   If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non- user settable breakpoints. */
4473
 
4474
static void
4475
breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag)
4476
{
4477
  struct breakpoint *b;
4478
  struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
4479
  int nr_printable_breakpoints;
4480
  struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
4481
  struct value_print_options opts;
4482
  int print_address_bits = 0;
4483
 
4484
  get_user_print_options (&opts);
4485
 
4486
  /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the
4487
     size required for address fields.  */
4488
  nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
4489
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4490
    if (bnum == -1
4491
        || bnum == b->number)
4492
      {
4493
        if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4494
          {
4495
            int addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4496
            if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4497
              print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4498
 
4499
            nr_printable_breakpoints++;
4500
          }
4501
      }
4502
 
4503
  if (opts.addressprint)
4504
    bkpttbl_chain
4505
      = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4506
                                             "BreakpointTable");
4507
  else
4508
    bkpttbl_chain
4509
      = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4510
                                             "BreakpointTable");
4511
 
4512
  if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4513
    annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
4514
  if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4515
    annotate_field (0);
4516
  ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num");             /* 1 */
4517
  if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4518
    annotate_field (1);
4519
  ui_out_table_header (uiout, 14, ui_left, "type", "Type");             /* 2 */
4520
  if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4521
    annotate_field (2);
4522
  ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp");              /* 3 */
4523
  if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4524
    annotate_field (3);
4525
  ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb");    /* 4 */
4526
  if (opts.addressprint)
4527
        {
4528
          if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4529
            annotate_field (4);
4530
          if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4531
            ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4532
          else
4533
            ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4534
        }
4535
  if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4536
    annotate_field (5);
4537
  ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What");  /* 6 */
4538
  ui_out_table_body (uiout);
4539
  if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4540
    annotate_breakpoints_table ();
4541
 
4542
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4543
    if (bnum == -1
4544
        || bnum == b->number)
4545
      {
4546
        /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
4547
           allflag is set. */
4548
        if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4549
          print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
4550
      }
4551
 
4552
  do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
4553
 
4554
  if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
4555
    {
4556
      if (bnum == -1)
4557
        ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
4558
      else
4559
        ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
4560
                        bnum);
4561
    }
4562
  else
4563
    {
4564
      if (last_loc && !server_command)
4565
        set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
4566
    }
4567
 
4568
  /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
4569
     there have been breakpoints? */
4570
  annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
4571
}
4572
 
4573
static void
4574
breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4575
{
4576
  int bnum = -1;
4577
 
4578
  if (bnum_exp)
4579
    bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4580
 
4581
  breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0);
4582
}
4583
 
4584
static void
4585
maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4586
{
4587
  int bnum = -1;
4588
 
4589
  if (bnum_exp)
4590
    bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4591
 
4592
  breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1);
4593
}
4594
 
4595
static int
4596
breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
4597
                   struct program_space *pspace,
4598
                   CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
4599
{
4600
  struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
4601
  for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
4602
    {
4603
      if (bl->pspace == pspace
4604
          && bl->address == pc
4605
          && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
4606
        return 1;
4607
    }
4608
  return 0;
4609
}
4610
 
4611
/* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC.  This
4612
   concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
4613
   address spaces.  */
4614
 
4615
static void
4616
describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4617
                            struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
4618
                            struct obj_section *section, int thread)
4619
{
4620
  int others = 0;
4621
  struct breakpoint *b;
4622
 
4623
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4624
    others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
4625
  if (others > 0)
4626
    {
4627
      if (others == 1)
4628
        printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
4629
      else /* if (others == ???) */
4630
        printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
4631
      ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4632
        if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
4633
          {
4634
            others--;
4635
            printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
4636
            if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
4637
              printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
4638
            else if (b->thread != -1)
4639
              printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
4640
            printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
4641
                             ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
4642
                               || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
4643
                               || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
4644
                              ? " (disabled)"
4645
                              : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
4646
                              ? " (permanent)"
4647
                              : ""),
4648
                             (others > 1) ? ","
4649
                             : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
4650
          }
4651
      printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
4652
      fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
4653
      printf_filtered (".\n");
4654
    }
4655
}
4656
 
4657
/* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
4658
   for the `break' command with no arguments.  */
4659
 
4660
void
4661
set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
4662
                        CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
4663
                        int line)
4664
{
4665
  default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
4666
  default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
4667
  default_breakpoint_address = addr;
4668
  default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
4669
  default_breakpoint_line = line;
4670
}
4671
 
4672
/* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
4673
   BPT.  For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
4674
   and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
4675
   (or use it for any other purpose either).
4676
 
4677
   More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will always
4678
   have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of
4679
   these types to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint at address zero:
4680
 
4681
      bp_watchpoint
4682
      bp_catchpoint
4683
 
4684
*/
4685
 
4686
static int
4687
breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4688
{
4689
  enum bptype type = bpt->type;
4690
 
4691
  return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
4692
}
4693
 
4694
/* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
4695
   true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location.  */
4696
 
4697
static int
4698
watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4699
{
4700
  return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
4701
          && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
4702
          && loc1->address == loc2->address
4703
          && loc1->length == loc2->length);
4704
}
4705
 
4706
/* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
4707
   same breakpoint location.  In most targets, this can only be true
4708
   if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2.  On targets that have global
4709
   breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter.  */
4710
 
4711
static int
4712
breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
4713
                          struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
4714
{
4715
  return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4716
           || aspace1 == aspace2)
4717
          && addr1 == addr2);
4718
}
4719
 
4720
/* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
4721
   (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
4722
   represent the same location.  */
4723
 
4724
static int
4725
breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4726
{
4727
  int hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
4728
  int hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
4729
 
4730
  if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
4731
    return 0;
4732
  else if (hw_point1)
4733
    return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
4734
  else
4735
    return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
4736
                                     loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
4737
}
4738
 
4739
static void
4740
breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
4741
                               int bnum, int have_bnum)
4742
{
4743
  char astr1[40];
4744
  char astr2[40];
4745
 
4746
  strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
4747
  strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
4748
  if (have_bnum)
4749
    warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
4750
             bnum, astr1, astr2);
4751
  else
4752
    warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
4753
}
4754
 
4755
/* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural constraints
4756
   on breakpoint placement.  Return the adjusted address.  Note: Very
4757
   few targets require this kind of adjustment.  For most targets,
4758
   this function is simply the identity function.  */
4759
 
4760
static CORE_ADDR
4761
adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4762
                           CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
4763
{
4764
  if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
4765
    {
4766
      /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment.  */
4767
      return bpaddr;
4768
    }
4769
  else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
4770
           || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4771
           || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
4772
           || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
4773
           || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
4774
    {
4775
      /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
4776
         have their addresses modified.  */
4777
      return bpaddr;
4778
    }
4779
  else
4780
    {
4781
      CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
4782
 
4783
      /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
4784
         of breakpoint instructions.  Obtain the adjusted address.  */
4785
      adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
4786
 
4787
      /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
4788
         a user's expectations.  Print a warning if an adjustment
4789
         is required.  */
4790
      if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
4791
        breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
4792
 
4793
      return adjusted_bpaddr;
4794
    }
4795
}
4796
 
4797
/* Allocate a struct bp_location.  */
4798
 
4799
static struct bp_location *
4800
allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4801
{
4802
  struct bp_location *loc, *loc_p;
4803
 
4804
  loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
4805
  memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
4806
 
4807
  loc->owner = bpt;
4808
  loc->cond = NULL;
4809
  loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
4810
  loc->enabled = 1;
4811
 
4812
  switch (bpt->type)
4813
    {
4814
    case bp_breakpoint:
4815
    case bp_until:
4816
    case bp_finish:
4817
    case bp_longjmp:
4818
    case bp_longjmp_resume:
4819
    case bp_step_resume:
4820
    case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4821
    case bp_call_dummy:
4822
    case bp_shlib_event:
4823
    case bp_thread_event:
4824
    case bp_overlay_event:
4825
    case bp_jit_event:
4826
    case bp_longjmp_master:
4827
      loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
4828
      break;
4829
    case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4830
      loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
4831
      break;
4832
    case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4833
    case bp_read_watchpoint:
4834
    case bp_access_watchpoint:
4835
      loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
4836
      break;
4837
    case bp_watchpoint:
4838
    case bp_catchpoint:
4839
    case bp_tracepoint:
4840
    case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4841
      loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
4842
      break;
4843
    default:
4844
      internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
4845
    }
4846
 
4847
  return loc;
4848
}
4849
 
4850
static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
4851
{
4852
  if (loc->cond)
4853
    xfree (loc->cond);
4854
 
4855
  if (loc->function_name)
4856
    xfree (loc->function_name);
4857
 
4858
  xfree (loc);
4859
}
4860
 
4861
/* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below.  Creates a breakpoint
4862
   that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet.  */
4863
/* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static.  */
4864
 
4865
static struct breakpoint *
4866
set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4867
                                     enum bptype bptype)
4868
{
4869
  struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
4870
 
4871
  b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
4872
  memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
4873
 
4874
  b->type = bptype;
4875
  b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
4876
  b->language = current_language->la_language;
4877
  b->input_radix = input_radix;
4878
  b->thread = -1;
4879
  b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
4880
  b->next = 0;
4881
  b->silent = 0;
4882
  b->ignore_count = 0;
4883
  b->commands = NULL;
4884
  b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
4885
  b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
4886
  b->exec_pathname = NULL;
4887
  b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
4888
  b->ops = NULL;
4889
  b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
4890
 
4891
  /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain
4892
     so that a list of breakpoints will come out in order
4893
     of increasing numbers.  */
4894
 
4895
  b1 = breakpoint_chain;
4896
  if (b1 == 0)
4897
    breakpoint_chain = b;
4898
  else
4899
    {
4900
      while (b1->next)
4901
        b1 = b1->next;
4902
      b1->next = b;
4903
    }
4904
  return b;
4905
}
4906
 
4907
/* Initialize loc->function_name.  */
4908
static void
4909
set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
4910
{
4911
  if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
4912
      || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4913
      || tracepoint_type (loc->owner))
4914
    {
4915
      find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
4916
                                NULL, NULL);
4917
      if (loc->function_name)
4918
        loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
4919
    }
4920
}
4921
 
4922
/* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL.  */
4923
static struct gdbarch *
4924
get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
4925
{
4926
  if (sal.section)
4927
    return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
4928
  if (sal.symtab)
4929
    return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
4930
 
4931
  return NULL;
4932
}
4933
 
4934
/* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
4935
   partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE.  The newly
4936
   created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
4937
   number are provided by SAL.  The newly created and partially
4938
   initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
4939
   is also returned as the value of this function.
4940
 
4941
   It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
4942
   the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
4943
   information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint.  In
4944
   particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
4945
   number!  Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
4946
   prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint.  If this
4947
   should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain.  */
4948
 
4949
struct breakpoint *
4950
set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4951
                    struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
4952
{
4953
  struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, bptype);
4954
  CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
4955
  struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
4956
 
4957
  loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
4958
  if (!loc_gdbarch)
4959
    loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
4960
 
4961
  if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
4962
    gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
4963
 
4964
  /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
4965
     Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
4966
     location will be placed on the location chain.  Adjustment of the
4967
     breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
4968
     not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
4969
     location that's only been partially initialized.  */
4970
  adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, sal.pc, b->type);
4971
 
4972
  b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
4973
  b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
4974
  b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
4975
  b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
4976
  b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
4977
 
4978
  /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
4979
     breakpoint resetting.  */
4980
  b->pspace = sal.pspace;
4981
 
4982
  if (sal.symtab == NULL)
4983
    b->source_file = NULL;
4984
  else
4985
    b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
4986
  b->loc->section = sal.section;
4987
  b->line_number = sal.line;
4988
 
4989
  set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
4990
 
4991
  breakpoints_changed ();
4992
 
4993
  return b;
4994
}
4995
 
4996
 
4997
/* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
4998
   instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code.  */
4999
void
5000
make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
5001
{
5002
  struct bp_location *bl;
5003
  b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
5004
 
5005
  /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the code.
5006
     Mark all locations as inserted.  For now, make_breakpoint_permanent
5007
     is called in just one place, so it's hard to say if it's reasonable
5008
     to have permanent breakpoint with multiple locations or not,
5009
     but it's easy to implmement.  */
5010
  for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5011
    bl->inserted = 1;
5012
}
5013
 
5014
/* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
5015
   if we do a longjmp() in THREAD.  When we hit that breakpoint, call
5016
   set_longjmp_resume_breakpoint() to figure out where we are going. */
5017
 
5018
void
5019
set_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5020
{
5021
  struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5022
 
5023
  /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
5024
     we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
5025
     longjmp "master" breakpoints.  Here, we simply create momentary
5026
     clones of those and enable them for the requested thread.  */
5027
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5028
    if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5029
        && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
5030
      {
5031
        struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5032
        clone->type = bp_longjmp;
5033
        clone->thread = thread;
5034
      }
5035
}
5036
 
5037
/* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD.  */
5038
void
5039
delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5040
{
5041
  struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5042
 
5043
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5044
    if (b->type == bp_longjmp)
5045
      {
5046
        if (b->thread == thread)
5047
          delete_breakpoint (b);
5048
      }
5049
}
5050
 
5051
void
5052
enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5053
{
5054
  struct breakpoint *b;
5055
 
5056
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5057
    if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5058
    {
5059
      b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5060
      update_global_location_list (1);
5061
      overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5062
    }
5063
}
5064
 
5065
void
5066
disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5067
{
5068
  struct breakpoint *b;
5069
 
5070
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5071
    if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5072
    {
5073
      b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5074
      update_global_location_list (0);
5075
      overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5076
    }
5077
}
5078
 
5079
struct breakpoint *
5080
create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5081
{
5082
  struct breakpoint *b;
5083
 
5084
  b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5085
 
5086
  b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5087
  /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me.  */
5088
  b->addr_string
5089
    = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5090
 
5091
  update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5092
 
5093
  return b;
5094
}
5095
 
5096
void
5097
remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5098
{
5099
  struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5100
 
5101
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5102
    if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5103
        && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5104
      delete_breakpoint (b);
5105
}
5106
 
5107
struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5108
  {
5109
    char **arg_p;
5110
    struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5111
    char ***addr_string_p;
5112
    int *not_found_ptr;
5113
  };
5114
 
5115
struct lang_and_radix
5116
  {
5117
    enum language lang;
5118
    int radix;
5119
  };
5120
 
5121
/* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration.  */
5122
 
5123
struct breakpoint *
5124
create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5125
{
5126
  struct breakpoint *b;
5127
 
5128
  b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5129
  update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5130
  return b;
5131
}
5132
 
5133
void
5134
remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5135
{
5136
  struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5137
 
5138
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5139
    if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5140
        && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5141
      delete_breakpoint (b);
5142
}
5143
 
5144
struct breakpoint *
5145
create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5146
{
5147
  struct breakpoint *b;
5148
 
5149
  b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5150
  update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5151
  return b;
5152
}
5153
 
5154
/* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries.  Only
5155
   apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled.  */
5156
 
5157
void
5158
disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5159
{
5160
  struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5161
 
5162
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5163
  {
5164
    struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5165
    /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled
5166
       for those with loc->duplicate set.  This is so that when breakpoint
5167
       becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to insert
5168
       all breakpoints.  If we don't set shlib_disabled here, we'll try
5169
       to insert those breakpoints and fail.  */
5170
    if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5171
         || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5172
         || (tracepoint_type (b)))
5173
        && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5174
        && !loc->shlib_disabled
5175
#ifdef PC_SOLIB
5176
        && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5177
#else
5178
        && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5179
#endif
5180
        )
5181
      {
5182
        loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5183
      }
5184
  }
5185
}
5186
 
5187
/* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library.  Only
5188
   apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled.  */
5189
 
5190
static void
5191
disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5192
{
5193
  struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5194
  int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5195
 
5196
  /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5197
     disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5198
     through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5199
     list.  See clear_solib for more information.  */
5200
  if (exec_bfd != NULL
5201
      && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5202
    return;
5203
 
5204
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5205
  {
5206
    struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5207
    if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5208
         || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5209
        && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5210
        && !loc->shlib_disabled
5211
        && (b->type == bp_breakpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5212
        && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5213
      {
5214
        loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5215
        /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5216
           succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5217
           to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints.  */
5218
        loc->inserted = 0;
5219
        if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5220
          {
5221
            target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5222
            warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5223
                     solib->so_name);
5224
          }
5225
        disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5226
      }
5227
  }
5228
}
5229
 
5230
/* FORK & VFORK catchpoints.  */
5231
 
5232
/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints.  */
5233
 
5234
static void
5235
insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5236
{
5237
  target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5238
}
5239
 
5240
/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints.  */
5241
 
5242
static int
5243
remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5244
{
5245
  return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5246
}
5247
 
5248
/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5249
   catchpoints.  */
5250
 
5251
static int
5252
breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5253
{
5254
  return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5255
}
5256
 
5257
/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints.  */
5258
 
5259
static enum print_stop_action
5260
print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5261
{
5262
  annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5263
  printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
5264
                   b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5265
  return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5266
}
5267
 
5268
/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints.  */
5269
 
5270
static void
5271
print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5272
{
5273
  struct value_print_options opts;
5274
 
5275
  get_user_print_options (&opts);
5276
 
5277
  /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5278
     not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5279
     is relatively readable).  */
5280
  if (opts.addressprint)
5281
    ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5282
  annotate_field (5);
5283
  ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
5284
  if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5285
    {
5286
      ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5287
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5288
                        ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5289
      ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5290
    }
5291
}
5292
 
5293
/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5294
   catchpoints.  */
5295
 
5296
static void
5297
print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5298
{
5299
  printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
5300
}
5301
 
5302
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints.  */
5303
 
5304
static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
5305
{
5306
  insert_catch_fork,
5307
  remove_catch_fork,
5308
  breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
5309
  print_it_catch_fork,
5310
  print_one_catch_fork,
5311
  print_mention_catch_fork
5312
};
5313
 
5314
/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints.  */
5315
 
5316
static void
5317
insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5318
{
5319
  target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5320
}
5321
 
5322
/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints.  */
5323
 
5324
static int
5325
remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5326
{
5327
  return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5328
}
5329
 
5330
/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5331
   catchpoints.  */
5332
 
5333
static int
5334
breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5335
{
5336
  return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5337
}
5338
 
5339
/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints.  */
5340
 
5341
static enum print_stop_action
5342
print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5343
{
5344
  annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5345
  printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
5346
                   b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5347
  return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5348
}
5349
 
5350
/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints.  */
5351
 
5352
static void
5353
print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5354
{
5355
  struct value_print_options opts;
5356
 
5357
  get_user_print_options (&opts);
5358
  /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5359
     not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5360
     is relatively readable).  */
5361
  if (opts.addressprint)
5362
    ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5363
  annotate_field (5);
5364
  ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
5365
  if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5366
    {
5367
      ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5368
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5369
                        ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5370
      ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5371
    }
5372
}
5373
 
5374
/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5375
   catchpoints.  */
5376
 
5377
static void
5378
print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5379
{
5380
  printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
5381
}
5382
 
5383
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints.  */
5384
 
5385
static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
5386
{
5387
  insert_catch_vfork,
5388
  remove_catch_vfork,
5389
  breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
5390
  print_it_catch_vfork,
5391
  print_one_catch_vfork,
5392
  print_mention_catch_vfork
5393
};
5394
 
5395
/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5396
   catchpoints.  */
5397
 
5398
static void
5399
insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5400
{
5401
  struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5402
 
5403
  ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
5404
  if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5405
    ++inf->any_syscall_count;
5406
  else
5407
    {
5408
      int i, iter;
5409
      for (i = 0;
5410
           VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5411
           i++)
5412
        {
5413
          int elem;
5414
          if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5415
            {
5416
              int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
5417
              uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
5418
              uintptr_t vec_addr;
5419
              VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
5420
              vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
5421
                vec_addr_offset;
5422
              memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
5423
                      (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
5424
            }
5425
          elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5426
          VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
5427
        }
5428
    }
5429
 
5430
  target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5431
                                 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5432
                                 inf->any_syscall_count,
5433
                                 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5434
                                 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5435
}
5436
 
5437
/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5438
   catchpoints.  */
5439
 
5440
static int
5441
remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5442
{
5443
  struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5444
 
5445
  --inf->total_syscalls_count;
5446
  if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5447
    --inf->any_syscall_count;
5448
  else
5449
    {
5450
      int i, iter;
5451
      for (i = 0;
5452
           VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5453
           i++)
5454
        {
5455
          int elem;
5456
          if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5457
            /* Shouldn't happen.  */
5458
            continue;
5459
          elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5460
          VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
5461
        }
5462
    }
5463
 
5464
  return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5465
                                        inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5466
                                        inf->any_syscall_count,
5467
                                        VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5468
                                        VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5469
}
5470
 
5471
/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5472
   catchpoints.  */
5473
 
5474
static int
5475
breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5476
{
5477
  /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this breakpoint.
5478
     If we are, then we must guarantee that the called syscall is the same
5479
     syscall we are catching.  */
5480
  int syscall_number = 0;
5481
 
5482
  if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
5483
    return 0;
5484
 
5485
  /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same.  */
5486
  if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5487
    {
5488
      int i, iter;
5489
      for (i = 0;
5490
           VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5491
           i++)
5492
        if (syscall_number == iter)
5493
          break;
5494
      /* Not the same.  */
5495
      if (!iter)
5496
        return 0;
5497
    }
5498
 
5499
  return 1;
5500
}
5501
 
5502
/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5503
   catchpoints.  */
5504
 
5505
static enum print_stop_action
5506
print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5507
{
5508
  /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
5509
     syscall is.  It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
5510
     or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
5511
     must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall".  */
5512
  ptid_t ptid;
5513
  struct target_waitstatus last;
5514
  struct syscall s;
5515
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
5516
  char *syscall_id;
5517
 
5518
  get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
5519
 
5520
  get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
5521
 
5522
  annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5523
 
5524
  if (s.name == NULL)
5525
    syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
5526
  else
5527
    syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
5528
 
5529
  old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
5530
 
5531
  if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
5532
    printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
5533
                     b->number, syscall_id);
5534
  else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
5535
    printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
5536
                     b->number, syscall_id);
5537
 
5538
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
5539
 
5540
  return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5541
}
5542
 
5543
/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5544
   catchpoints.  */
5545
 
5546
static void
5547
print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
5548
                         struct bp_location **last_loc)
5549
{
5550
  struct value_print_options opts;
5551
 
5552
  get_user_print_options (&opts);
5553
  /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5554
     not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5555
     is relatively readable).  */
5556
  if (opts.addressprint)
5557
    ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5558
  annotate_field (5);
5559
 
5560
  if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
5561
      && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5562
    ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
5563
  else
5564
    ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
5565
 
5566
  if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5567
    {
5568
      int i, iter;
5569
      char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
5570
      for (i = 0;
5571
           VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5572
           i++)
5573
        {
5574
          char *x = text;
5575
          struct syscall s;
5576
          get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5577
 
5578
          if (s.name != NULL)
5579
            text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
5580
          else
5581
            text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
5582
 
5583
          /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
5584
             because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
5585
             on every call.  */
5586
          xfree (x);
5587
        }
5588
      /* Remove the last comma.  */
5589
      text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
5590
      ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
5591
    }
5592
  else
5593
    ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
5594
  ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5595
}
5596
 
5597
/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5598
   catchpoints.  */
5599
 
5600
static void
5601
print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5602
{
5603
  if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5604
    {
5605
      int i, iter;
5606
 
5607
      if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5608
        printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
5609
      else
5610
        printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
5611
 
5612
      for (i = 0;
5613
           VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5614
           i++)
5615
        {
5616
          struct syscall s;
5617
          get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5618
 
5619
          if (s.name)
5620
            printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
5621
          else
5622
            printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
5623
        }
5624
      printf_filtered (")");
5625
    }
5626
  else
5627
    printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
5628
                     b->number);
5629
}
5630
 
5631
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints.  */
5632
 
5633
static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
5634
{
5635
  insert_catch_syscall,
5636
  remove_catch_syscall,
5637
  breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
5638
  print_it_catch_syscall,
5639
  print_one_catch_syscall,
5640
  print_mention_catch_syscall
5641
};
5642
 
5643
/* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint.  */
5644
 
5645
static int
5646
syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5647
{
5648
  return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
5649
}
5650
 
5651
/* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
5652
   but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
5653
   This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
5654
   struct breakpoint before calling mention.
5655
 
5656
   If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5657
   If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5658
   OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5659
   to the catchpoint.  */
5660
 
5661
static struct breakpoint *
5662
create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5663
                                   char *cond_string,
5664
                                   struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5665
{
5666
  struct symtab_and_line sal;
5667
  struct breakpoint *b;
5668
 
5669
  init_sal (&sal);
5670
  sal.pspace = current_program_space;
5671
 
5672
  b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
5673
  set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
5674
  b->number = breakpoint_count;
5675
 
5676
  b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
5677
  b->thread = -1;
5678
  b->addr_string = NULL;
5679
  b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5680
  b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
5681
  b->ops = ops;
5682
 
5683
  return b;
5684
}
5685
 
5686
/* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
5687
 
5688
   If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5689
   If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5690
   OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5691
   to the catchpoint.  */
5692
 
5693
static struct breakpoint *
5694
create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5695
                   char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5696
{
5697
  struct breakpoint *b =
5698
    create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5699
 
5700
  mention (b);
5701
  update_global_location_list (1);
5702
 
5703
  return b;
5704
}
5705
 
5706
static void
5707
create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5708
                                    int tempflag, char *cond_string,
5709
                                    struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5710
{
5711
  struct breakpoint *b
5712
    = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5713
 
5714
  /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
5715
     area.  */
5716
  b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5717
}
5718
 
5719
/* Exec catchpoints.  */
5720
 
5721
static void
5722
insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5723
{
5724
  target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5725
}
5726
 
5727
static int
5728
remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5729
{
5730
  return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5731
}
5732
 
5733
static int
5734
breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5735
{
5736
  return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
5737
}
5738
 
5739
static enum print_stop_action
5740
print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5741
{
5742
  annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5743
  printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
5744
                   b->exec_pathname);
5745
  return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5746
}
5747
 
5748
static void
5749
print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5750
{
5751
  struct value_print_options opts;
5752
 
5753
  get_user_print_options (&opts);
5754
 
5755
  /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5756
     not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5757
     is relatively readable).  */
5758
  if (opts.addressprint)
5759
    ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5760
  annotate_field (5);
5761
  ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
5762
  if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
5763
    {
5764
      ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
5765
      ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
5766
      ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5767
    }
5768
}
5769
 
5770
static void
5771
print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5772
{
5773
  printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
5774
}
5775
 
5776
static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
5777
{
5778
  insert_catch_exec,
5779
  remove_catch_exec,
5780
  breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
5781
  print_it_catch_exec,
5782
  print_one_catch_exec,
5783
  print_mention_catch_exec
5784
};
5785
 
5786
static void
5787
create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
5788
                                 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5789
{
5790
  struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
5791
  struct breakpoint *b =
5792
    create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
5793
 
5794
  b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
5795
 
5796
  /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
5797
     location list.  */
5798
  mention (b);
5799
  update_global_location_list (1);
5800
}
5801
 
5802
static int
5803
hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
5804
{
5805
  struct breakpoint *b;
5806
  int i = 0;
5807
 
5808
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5809
  {
5810
    if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5811
      i++;
5812
  }
5813
 
5814
  return i;
5815
}
5816
 
5817
static int
5818
hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
5819
{
5820
  struct breakpoint *b;
5821
  int i = 0;
5822
 
5823
  *other_type_used = 0;
5824
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5825
  {
5826
    if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
5827
      {
5828
        if (b->type == type)
5829
          i++;
5830
        else if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5831
                  || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
5832
                  || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5833
          *other_type_used = 1;
5834
      }
5835
  }
5836
  return i;
5837
}
5838
 
5839
void
5840
disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
5841
{
5842
  struct breakpoint *b;
5843
 
5844
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5845
  {
5846
    if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5847
         || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5848
         || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5849
         || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5850
        && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5851
      {
5852
        b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
5853
        update_global_location_list (0);
5854
      }
5855
  }
5856
}
5857
 
5858
void
5859
enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
5860
{
5861
  struct breakpoint *b;
5862
 
5863
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5864
  {
5865
    if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5866
         || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5867
         || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5868
         || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5869
        && (b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled))
5870
      {
5871
        b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5872
        update_global_location_list (1);
5873
      }
5874
  }
5875
}
5876
 
5877
void
5878
disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
5879
{
5880
  struct breakpoint *b;
5881
  int found = 0;
5882
 
5883
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5884
    {
5885
      if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5886
        continue;
5887
 
5888
      if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5889
           || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5890
          && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5891
        {
5892
          b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
5893
          found = 1;
5894
        }
5895
    }
5896
 
5897
  if (found)
5898
    update_global_location_list (0);
5899
 
5900
  current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
5901
}
5902
 
5903
void
5904
enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
5905
{
5906
  struct breakpoint *b;
5907
  int found = 0;
5908
 
5909
  current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
5910
 
5911
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5912
    {
5913
      if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5914
        continue;
5915
 
5916
      if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5917
           || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5918
          && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
5919
        {
5920
          b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5921
          found = 1;
5922
        }
5923
    }
5924
 
5925
  if (found)
5926
    breakpoint_re_set ();
5927
}
5928
 
5929
 
5930
/* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
5931
   at address specified by SAL.
5932
   Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero.  */
5933
 
5934
struct breakpoint *
5935
set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
5936
                          struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
5937
{
5938
  struct breakpoint *b;
5939
 
5940
  /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
5941
     one.  */
5942
  gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
5943
 
5944
  b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
5945
  b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5946
  b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5947
  b->frame_id = frame_id;
5948
 
5949
  /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we
5950
     want momentary breakpoints to be active in only a
5951
     single thread of control.  */
5952
  if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
5953
    b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
5954
 
5955
  update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5956
 
5957
  return b;
5958
}
5959
 
5960
/* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG.  Returns NULL if
5961
   ORIG is NULL.  */
5962
 
5963
struct breakpoint *
5964
clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
5965
{
5966
  struct breakpoint *copy;
5967
 
5968
  /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing.  */
5969
  if (orig == NULL)
5970
    return NULL;
5971
 
5972
  copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
5973
  copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
5974
  set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
5975
 
5976
  copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
5977
  copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
5978
  copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
5979
  copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
5980
  copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
5981
 
5982
  if (orig->source_file == NULL)
5983
    copy->source_file = NULL;
5984
  else
5985
    copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
5986
 
5987
  copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
5988
  copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
5989
  copy->thread = orig->thread;
5990
  copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
5991
 
5992
  copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5993
  copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5994
  copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
5995
 
5996
  update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
5997
  return copy;
5998
}
5999
 
6000
struct breakpoint *
6001
set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
6002
                                enum bptype type)
6003
{
6004
  struct symtab_and_line sal;
6005
 
6006
  sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
6007
  sal.pc = pc;
6008
  sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
6009
  sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6010
 
6011
  return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
6012
}
6013
 
6014
 
6015
/* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B.  */
6016
 
6017
static void
6018
mention (struct breakpoint *b)
6019
{
6020
  int say_where = 0;
6021
  struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
6022
  struct value_print_options opts;
6023
 
6024
  get_user_print_options (&opts);
6025
 
6026
  /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
6027
     hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation.  It should
6028
     be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
6029
     random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook.  */
6030
  observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
6031
 
6032
  if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6033
    b->ops->print_mention (b);
6034
  else
6035
    switch (b->type)
6036
      {
6037
      case bp_none:
6038
        printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6039
        break;
6040
      case bp_watchpoint:
6041
        ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6042
        ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6043
        ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6044
        ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6045
        ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6046
        do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6047
        break;
6048
      case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6049
        ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6050
        ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6051
        ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6052
        ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6053
        ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6054
        do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6055
        break;
6056
      case bp_read_watchpoint:
6057
        ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6058
        ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6059
        ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6060
        ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6061
        ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6062
        do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6063
        break;
6064
      case bp_access_watchpoint:
6065
        ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6066
        ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6067
        ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6068
        ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6069
        ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6070
        do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6071
        break;
6072
      case bp_breakpoint:
6073
        if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6074
          {
6075
            say_where = 0;
6076
            break;
6077
          }
6078
        if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6079
          printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6080
        else
6081
          printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6082
        printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6083
        say_where = 1;
6084
        break;
6085
      case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6086
        if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6087
          {
6088
            say_where = 0;
6089
            break;
6090
          }
6091
        printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6092
        say_where = 1;
6093
        break;
6094
      case bp_tracepoint:
6095
        if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6096
          {
6097
            say_where = 0;
6098
            break;
6099
          }
6100
        printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6101
        printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6102
        say_where = 1;
6103
        break;
6104
      case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6105
        if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6106
          {
6107
            say_where = 0;
6108
            break;
6109
          }
6110
        printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
6111
        printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6112
        say_where = 1;
6113
        break;
6114
 
6115
      case bp_until:
6116
      case bp_finish:
6117
      case bp_longjmp:
6118
      case bp_longjmp_resume:
6119
      case bp_step_resume:
6120
      case bp_call_dummy:
6121
      case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6122
      case bp_shlib_event:
6123
      case bp_thread_event:
6124
      case bp_overlay_event:
6125
      case bp_jit_event:
6126
      case bp_longjmp_master:
6127
        break;
6128
      }
6129
 
6130
  if (say_where)
6131
    {
6132
      /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6133
         single string.  */
6134
      if (b->loc == NULL)
6135
        {
6136
          printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6137
        }
6138
      else
6139
        {
6140
          if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6141
            {
6142
              printf_filtered (" at ");
6143
              fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6144
                              gdb_stdout);
6145
            }
6146
          if (b->source_file)
6147
            printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6148
                             b->source_file, b->line_number);
6149
 
6150
          if (b->loc->next)
6151
            {
6152
              struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6153
              int n = 0;
6154
              for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6155
                ++n;
6156
              printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6157
            }
6158
 
6159
        }
6160
    }
6161
  if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6162
    return;
6163
  printf_filtered ("\n");
6164
}
6165
 
6166
 
6167
static struct bp_location *
6168
add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6169
                            const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6170
{
6171
  struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6172
 
6173
  loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6174
  for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6175
    ;
6176
  *tmp = loc;
6177
  loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6178
  if (!loc->gdbarch)
6179
    loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6180
  loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
6181
  loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6182
                                            loc->requested_address, b->type);
6183
  loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
6184
  gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
6185
  loc->section = sal->section;
6186
 
6187
  set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
6188
  return loc;
6189
}
6190
 
6191
 
6192
/* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
6193
   return 0 otherwise.  */
6194
 
6195
static int
6196
bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
6197
{
6198
  int len;
6199
  CORE_ADDR addr;
6200
  const gdb_byte *brk;
6201
  gdb_byte *target_mem;
6202
  struct cleanup *cleanup;
6203
  int retval = 0;
6204
 
6205
  gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
6206
 
6207
  addr = loc->address;
6208
  brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
6209
 
6210
  /* Software breakpoints unsupported?  */
6211
  if (brk == NULL)
6212
    return 0;
6213
 
6214
  target_mem = alloca (len);
6215
 
6216
  /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
6217
     we read the memory.  Otherwise we could say about our temporary
6218
     breakpoints they are permanent.  */
6219
  cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6220
 
6221
  switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
6222
  make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
6223
 
6224
  if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
6225
      && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
6226
    retval = 1;
6227
 
6228
  do_cleanups (cleanup);
6229
 
6230
  return retval;
6231
}
6232
 
6233
 
6234
 
6235
/* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location.  Use ADDR_STRING
6236
   as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
6237
   as condition expression.  */
6238
 
6239
static void
6240
create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6241
                   struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
6242
                   char *cond_string,
6243
                   enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6244
                   int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6245
                   struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, int enabled)
6246
{
6247
  struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
6248
  int i;
6249
 
6250
  if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6251
    {
6252
      int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
6253
      int target_resources_ok =
6254
        target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
6255
                                            i + 1, 0);
6256
      if (target_resources_ok == 0)
6257
        error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
6258
      else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
6259
        error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
6260
    }
6261
 
6262
  gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
6263
 
6264
  for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6265
    {
6266
      struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
6267
      struct bp_location *loc;
6268
 
6269
      if (from_tty)
6270
        {
6271
          struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
6272
          if (!loc_gdbarch)
6273
            loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
6274
 
6275
          describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
6276
                                      sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
6277
        }
6278
 
6279
      if (i == 0)
6280
        {
6281
          b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6282
          set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6283
          b->number = breakpoint_count;
6284
          b->thread = thread;
6285
          b->task = task;
6286
 
6287
          b->cond_string = cond_string;
6288
          b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6289
          b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6290
          b->disposition = disposition;
6291
 
6292
          b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
6293
 
6294
          if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6295
              && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6296
                  || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6297
            b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6298
 
6299
          loc = b->loc;
6300
        }
6301
      else
6302
        {
6303
          loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6304
        }
6305
 
6306
      if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
6307
        make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
6308
 
6309
      if (b->cond_string)
6310
        {
6311
          char *arg = b->cond_string;
6312
          loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
6313
          if (*arg)
6314
              error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
6315
        }
6316
    }
6317
 
6318
  if (addr_string)
6319
    b->addr_string = addr_string;
6320
  else
6321
    /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
6322
       me.  */
6323
    b->addr_string
6324
      = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6325
 
6326
  b->ops = ops;
6327
  mention (b);
6328
}
6329
 
6330
/* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
6331
   elements to fill the void space.  */
6332
static void
6333
remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
6334
{
6335
  int i = index_to_remove+1;
6336
  int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
6337
 
6338
  for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
6339
    sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
6340
 
6341
  --(sal->nelts);
6342
}
6343
 
6344
/* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
6345
   and line as SAL, in all program spaces.  Users debugging with IDEs,
6346
   will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
6347
   about program spaces.  This is done only if SAL does not have
6348
   explicit PC and has line and file information.  If we got just a
6349
   single expanded sal, return the original.
6350
 
6351
   Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
6352
   which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL.  This
6353
   makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
6354
   instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
6355
   the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'.  */
6356
 
6357
static struct symtabs_and_lines
6358
expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
6359
{
6360
  struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
6361
  CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
6362
  char *original_function = NULL;
6363
  int found;
6364
  int i;
6365
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
6366
 
6367
  /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
6368
     If we have no line number, we can't expand.  */
6369
  if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
6370
    {
6371
      expanded.nelts = 1;
6372
      expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6373
      expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6374
      return expanded;
6375
    }
6376
 
6377
  sal.pc = 0;
6378
 
6379
  old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6380
 
6381
  switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
6382
 
6383
  find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
6384
 
6385
  /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces.  */
6386
  expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
6387
 
6388
  if (expanded.nelts == 1)
6389
    {
6390
      /* We had one sal, we got one sal.  Return that sal, adjusting it
6391
         past the function prologue if necessary.  */
6392
      xfree (expanded.sals);
6393
      expanded.nelts = 1;
6394
      expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6395
      sal.pc = original_pc;
6396
      expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6397
      skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
6398
      do_cleanups (old_chain);
6399
      return expanded;
6400
    }
6401
 
6402
  if (!sal.explicit_line)
6403
    {
6404
      CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
6405
      for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6406
        {
6407
          CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
6408
          char *this_function;
6409
 
6410
          /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
6411
             read memory.  */
6412
          switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
6413
 
6414
          if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
6415
                                        &func_addr, &func_end))
6416
            {
6417
              if (this_function
6418
                  && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
6419
                {
6420
                  remove_sal (&expanded, i);
6421
                  --i;
6422
                }
6423
              else if (func_addr == pc)
6424
                {
6425
                  /* We're at beginning of a function, and should
6426
                     skip prologue.  */
6427
                  struct symbol *sym = find_pc_function (pc);
6428
                  if (sym)
6429
                    expanded.sals[i] = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6430
                  else
6431
                    {
6432
                      /* Since find_pc_partial_function returned true,
6433
                         we should really always find the section here.  */
6434
                      struct obj_section *section = find_pc_section (pc);
6435
                      if (section)
6436
                        {
6437
                          struct gdbarch *gdbarch
6438
                            = get_objfile_arch (section->objfile);
6439
                          expanded.sals[i].pc
6440
                            = gdbarch_skip_prologue (gdbarch, pc);
6441
                        }
6442
                    }
6443
                }
6444
            }
6445
        }
6446
    }
6447
  else
6448
    {
6449
      for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6450
        {
6451
          /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a
6452
             line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary.  */
6453
          skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
6454
        }
6455
    }
6456
 
6457
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
6458
 
6459
  if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
6460
    {
6461
      /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero
6462
       expanded sals then something is really wrong.
6463
      Fix that by returnign the original sal. */
6464
      xfree (expanded.sals);
6465
      expanded.nelts = 1;
6466
      expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6467
      sal.pc = original_pc;
6468
      expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6469
      return expanded;
6470
    }
6471
 
6472
  if (original_pc)
6473
    {
6474
      found = 0;
6475
      for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6476
        if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
6477
          {
6478
            found = 1;
6479
            break;
6480
          }
6481
      gdb_assert (found);
6482
    }
6483
 
6484
  return expanded;
6485
}
6486
 
6487
/* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table.  For each
6488
   SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
6489
   value.  COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
6490
   used for all breakpoints.  Essentially the only case where
6491
   SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
6492
   function.  In that case, it's still not possible to specify
6493
   separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
6494
   we take just a single condition string.
6495
 
6496
   NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
6497
   the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
6498
   array contents).  If the function fails (error() is called), the
6499
   caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
6500
   COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
6501
 
6502
static void
6503
create_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6504
                    struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
6505
                    char *cond_string,
6506
                    enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6507
                    int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6508
                    struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
6509
                    int enabled)
6510
{
6511
  int i;
6512
  for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6513
    {
6514
      struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
6515
        expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
6516
 
6517
      create_breakpoint (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
6518
                         cond_string, type, disposition,
6519
                         thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6520
    }
6521
}
6522
 
6523
/* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
6524
   followed by conditionals.  On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
6525
   addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
6526
   address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
6527
 
6528
static void
6529
parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
6530
                       struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6531
                       char ***addr_string,
6532
                       int *not_found_ptr)
6533
{
6534
  char *addr_start = *address;
6535
  *addr_string = NULL;
6536
  /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
6537
     breakpoint. */
6538
  if ((*address) == NULL
6539
      || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
6540
    {
6541
      if (default_breakpoint_valid)
6542
        {
6543
          struct symtab_and_line sal;
6544
          init_sal (&sal);              /* initialize to zeroes */
6545
          sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
6546
            xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6547
          sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
6548
          sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
6549
          sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
6550
          sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
6551
          sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
6552
 
6553
          /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" where PC is
6554
             the default_breakpoint_address.  So make sure to set
6555
             sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to expand the list of
6556
             sals to include all other instances with the same symtab and line.
6557
           */
6558
          sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6559
 
6560
          sals->sals[0] = sal;
6561
          sals->nelts = 1;
6562
        }
6563
      else
6564
        error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
6565
    }
6566
  else
6567
    {
6568
      /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
6569
         current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).  This
6570
         should produce the results we want almost all of the time while
6571
         leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
6572
         ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
6573
         may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
6574
 
6575
      struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
6576
 
6577
      if (default_breakpoint_valid
6578
          && (!cursal.symtab
6579
              || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
6580
                  && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
6581
        *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
6582
                               default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
6583
                               not_found_ptr);
6584
      else
6585
        *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
6586
                               addr_string, not_found_ptr);
6587
    }
6588
  /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
6589
  if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
6590
    *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
6591
  if (addr_start != (*address))
6592
    {
6593
      int i;
6594
      for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6595
        {
6596
          /* Add the string if not present. */
6597
          if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
6598
            (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start, (*address) - addr_start);
6599
        }
6600
    }
6601
}
6602
 
6603
 
6604
/* Convert each SAL into a real PC.  Verify that the PC can be
6605
   inserted as a breakpoint.  If it can't throw an error. */
6606
 
6607
static void
6608
breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6609
                       char *address)
6610
{
6611
  int i;
6612
  for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6613
    resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
6614
}
6615
 
6616
/* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations.  For
6617
   instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
6618
   likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
6619
   only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
6620
   multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
6621
   it, etc.  */
6622
 
6623
static void
6624
check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6625
                            struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
6626
{
6627
  int i, rslt;
6628
  struct symtab_and_line *sal;
6629
  char *msg;
6630
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
6631
 
6632
  for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6633
    {
6634
      sal = &sals->sals[i];
6635
 
6636
      rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (gdbarch, sal->pc,
6637
                                               NULL, &msg);
6638
      old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
6639
 
6640
      if (!rslt)
6641
        error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
6642
               paddress (gdbarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
6643
 
6644
      do_cleanups (old_chain);
6645
    }
6646
}
6647
 
6648
static void
6649
do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
6650
{
6651
  struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
6652
 
6653
  parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
6654
                         args->not_found_ptr);
6655
}
6656
 
6657
/* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
6658
   accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
6659
   string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
6660
   PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
6661
   If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
6662
   If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1.  */
6663
static void
6664
find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
6665
                           char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
6666
{
6667
  *cond_string = NULL;
6668
  *thread = -1;
6669
  while (tok && *tok)
6670
    {
6671
      char *end_tok;
6672
      int toklen;
6673
      char *cond_start = NULL;
6674
      char *cond_end = NULL;
6675
      while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
6676
        tok++;
6677
 
6678
      end_tok = tok;
6679
 
6680
      while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
6681
        end_tok++;
6682
 
6683
      toklen = end_tok - tok;
6684
 
6685
      if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
6686
        {
6687
          struct expression *expr;
6688
 
6689
          tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
6690
          expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
6691
          xfree (expr);
6692
          cond_end = tok;
6693
          *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
6694
                                     cond_end - cond_start);
6695
        }
6696
      else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
6697
        {
6698
          char *tmptok;
6699
 
6700
          tok = end_tok + 1;
6701
          tmptok = tok;
6702
          *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6703
          if (tok == tmptok)
6704
            error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
6705
          if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
6706
            error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
6707
        }
6708
      else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
6709
        {
6710
          char *tmptok;
6711
 
6712
          tok = end_tok + 1;
6713
          tmptok = tok;
6714
          *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6715
          if (tok == tmptok)
6716
            error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
6717
          if (!valid_task_id (*task))
6718
            error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
6719
        }
6720
      else
6721
        error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
6722
    }
6723
}
6724
 
6725
/* Set a breakpoint.  This function is shared between CLI and MI
6726
   functions for setting a breakpoint.  This function has two major
6727
   modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD
6728
   parameter.  If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
6729
   breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise, ARG is just the
6730
   location of breakpoint, with condition and thread specified by the
6731
   COND_STRING and THREAD parameters.  Returns true if any breakpoint
6732
   was created; false otherwise.  */
6733
 
6734
static int
6735
break_command_really (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6736
                      char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
6737
                      int parse_condition_and_thread,
6738
                      int tempflag, int hardwareflag, int traceflag,
6739
                      int ignore_count,
6740
                      enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
6741
                      struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
6742
                      int from_tty,
6743
                      int enabled)
6744
{
6745
  struct gdb_exception e;
6746
  struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
6747
  struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
6748
  char *copy_arg;
6749
  char *err_msg;
6750
  char *addr_start = arg;
6751
  char **addr_string;
6752
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
6753
  struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
6754
  struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
6755
  int i;
6756
  int pending = 0;
6757
  int not_found = 0;
6758
  enum bptype type_wanted;
6759
  int task = 0;
6760
 
6761
  sals.sals = NULL;
6762
  sals.nelts = 0;
6763
  addr_string = NULL;
6764
 
6765
  parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
6766
  parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
6767
  parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
6768
  parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
6769
 
6770
  e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
6771
                       &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
6772
 
6773
  /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value.  */
6774
  switch (e.reason)
6775
    {
6776
    case RETURN_QUIT:
6777
      throw_exception (e);
6778
    case RETURN_ERROR:
6779
      switch (e.error)
6780
        {
6781
        case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
6782
 
6783
          /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
6784
             error.  */
6785
 
6786
          if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
6787
            throw_exception (e);
6788
 
6789
          exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
6790
 
6791
          /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
6792
             selects no, then simply return the error code.  */
6793
          if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
6794
              && !nquery ("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? "))
6795
            return 0;
6796
 
6797
          /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
6798
             a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
6799
             breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
6800
             is defaulted on behalf of the user.  */
6801
          copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
6802
          addr_string = &copy_arg;
6803
          sals.nelts = 1;
6804
          sals.sals = &pending_sal;
6805
          pending_sal.pc = 0;
6806
          pending = 1;
6807
          break;
6808
        default:
6809
          throw_exception (e);
6810
        }
6811
    default:
6812
      if (!sals.nelts)
6813
        return 0;
6814
    }
6815
 
6816
  /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
6817
  old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6818
 
6819
  if (!pending)
6820
    {
6821
      /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed.  */
6822
      make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
6823
 
6824
      /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
6825
      make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
6826
    }
6827
 
6828
  /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
6829
     Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
6830
     to be part of a breakpoint.  If the breakpoint create succeeds
6831
     then the memory is not reclaimed.  */
6832
  bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6833
 
6834
  /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup.  These go on
6835
     the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails.  */
6836
  for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
6837
    {
6838
      if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
6839
        make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
6840
    }
6841
 
6842
  /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
6843
     are ok for the target.  */
6844
  if (!pending)
6845
    breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals, addr_start);
6846
 
6847
  type_wanted = (traceflag
6848
                 ? (hardwareflag ? bp_fast_tracepoint : bp_tracepoint)
6849
                 : (hardwareflag ? bp_hardware_breakpoint : bp_breakpoint));
6850
 
6851
  /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location.  */
6852
  if (type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
6853
    check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &sals);
6854
 
6855
  /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
6856
     breakpoints.  Allocate a separate condition expression for each
6857
     breakpoint. */
6858
  if (!pending)
6859
    {
6860
      if (parse_condition_and_thread)
6861
        {
6862
            /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
6863
               from thread number, so parsing in context of first
6864
               sal is OK.  When setting the breakpoint we'll
6865
               re-parse it in context of each sal.  */
6866
            cond_string = NULL;
6867
            thread = -1;
6868
            find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
6869
                                       &thread, &task);
6870
            if (cond_string)
6871
                make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6872
        }
6873
      else
6874
        {
6875
            /* Create a private copy of condition string.  */
6876
            if (cond_string)
6877
            {
6878
                cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
6879
                make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6880
            }
6881
        }
6882
      create_breakpoints (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string, type_wanted,
6883
                          tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
6884
                          thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6885
    }
6886
  else
6887
    {
6888
      struct symtab_and_line sal = {0};
6889
      struct breakpoint *b;
6890
 
6891
      make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
6892
 
6893
      b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
6894
      set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6895
      b->number = breakpoint_count;
6896
      b->thread = -1;
6897
      b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
6898
      b->cond_string = NULL;
6899
      b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6900
      b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
6901
      b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
6902
      b->ops = ops;
6903
      b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6904
      b->pspace = current_program_space;
6905
 
6906
      if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6907
          && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6908
              || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6909
        b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6910
 
6911
      mention (b);
6912
    }
6913
 
6914
  if (sals.nelts > 1)
6915
    warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
6916
               "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
6917
  /* That's it.  Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
6918
     breakpoint.  */
6919
  discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6920
  /* But cleanup everything else.  */
6921
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
6922
 
6923
  /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded.  */
6924
  update_global_location_list (1);
6925
 
6926
  return 1;
6927
}
6928
 
6929
/* Set a breakpoint.
6930
   ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
6931
   condition, and thread.
6932
   FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
6933
   and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
6934
   and BP_TEMPFLAG.  */
6935
 
6936
static void
6937
break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
6938
{
6939
  int hardwareflag = flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG;
6940
  int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
6941
 
6942
  break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
6943
                        arg,
6944
                        NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
6945
                        tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6946
 
6947
                        pending_break_support,
6948
                        NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
6949
                        from_tty,
6950
                        1 /* enabled */);
6951
}
6952
 
6953
 
6954
void
6955
set_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6956
                char *address, char *condition,
6957
                int hardwareflag, int tempflag,
6958
                int thread, int ignore_count,
6959
                int pending, int enabled)
6960
{
6961
  break_command_really (gdbarch,
6962
                        address, condition, thread,
6963
 
6964
                        tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6965
                        ignore_count,
6966
                        pending
6967
                        ? AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE : AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE,
6968
                        NULL, 0, enabled);
6969
}
6970
 
6971
/* Adjust SAL to the first instruction past the function prologue.
6972
   The end of the prologue is determined using the line table from
6973
   the debugging information.  explicit_pc and explicit_line are
6974
   not modified.
6975
 
6976
   If SAL is already past the prologue, then do nothing.  */
6977
 
6978
static void
6979
skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6980
{
6981
  struct symbol *sym;
6982
  struct symtab_and_line start_sal;
6983
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
6984
 
6985
  old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6986
 
6987
  sym = find_pc_function (sal->pc);
6988
  if (sym != NULL)
6989
    {
6990
      start_sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6991
      if (sal->pc < start_sal.pc)
6992
        {
6993
          start_sal.explicit_line = sal->explicit_line;
6994
          start_sal.explicit_pc = sal->explicit_pc;
6995
          *sal = start_sal;
6996
        }
6997
    }
6998
 
6999
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
7000
}
7001
 
7002
/* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command.  */
7003
 
7004
void
7005
resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7006
{
7007
  CORE_ADDR pc;
7008
 
7009
  if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7010
    {
7011
      if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
7012
        error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
7013
               sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
7014
      sal->pc = pc;
7015
 
7016
      /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using
7017
         a line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary.  */
7018
      if (sal->explicit_line)
7019
        {
7020
          /* Preserve the original line number.  */
7021
          int saved_line = sal->line;
7022
          skip_prologue_sal (sal);
7023
          sal->line = saved_line;
7024
        }
7025
    }
7026
 
7027
  if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7028
    {
7029
      struct blockvector *bv;
7030
      struct block *b;
7031
      struct symbol *sym;
7032
 
7033
      bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
7034
      if (bv != NULL)
7035
        {
7036
          sym = block_linkage_function (b);
7037
          if (sym != NULL)
7038
            {
7039
              fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
7040
              sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
7041
            }
7042
          else
7043
            {
7044
              /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll just
7045
                 have to look harder. This case can be executed if we have
7046
                 line numbers but no functions (as can happen in assembly
7047
                 source).  */
7048
 
7049
              struct minimal_symbol *msym;
7050
              struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7051
 
7052
              switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
7053
 
7054
              msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
7055
              if (msym)
7056
                sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
7057
 
7058
              do_cleanups (old_chain);
7059
            }
7060
        }
7061
    }
7062
}
7063
 
7064
void
7065
break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7066
{
7067
  break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7068
}
7069
 
7070
void
7071
tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7072
{
7073
  break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
7074
}
7075
 
7076
static void
7077
hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7078
{
7079
  break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
7080
}
7081
 
7082
static void
7083
thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7084
{
7085
  break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
7086
}
7087
 
7088
static void
7089
stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7090
{
7091
  printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
7092
Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
7093
       stop at <line>\n"));
7094
}
7095
 
7096
static void
7097
stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7098
{
7099
  int badInput = 0;
7100
 
7101
  if (arg == (char *) NULL)
7102
    badInput = 1;
7103
  else if (*arg != '*')
7104
    {
7105
      char *argptr = arg;
7106
      int hasColon = 0;
7107
 
7108
      /* look for a ':'.  If this is a line number specification, then
7109
         say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
7110
         function/method name */
7111
      while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7112
        {
7113
          hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7114
          argptr++;
7115
        }
7116
 
7117
      if (hasColon)
7118
        badInput = (*argptr != ':');    /* Not a class::method */
7119
      else
7120
        badInput = isdigit (*arg);      /* a simple line number */
7121
    }
7122
 
7123
  if (badInput)
7124
    printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
7125
  else
7126
    break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7127
}
7128
 
7129
static void
7130
stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7131
{
7132
  int badInput = 0;
7133
 
7134
  if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*')      /* no line number */
7135
    badInput = 1;
7136
  else
7137
    {
7138
      char *argptr = arg;
7139
      int hasColon = 0;
7140
 
7141
      /* look for a ':'.  If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
7142
         it is probably a line number. */
7143
      while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7144
        {
7145
          hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7146
          argptr++;
7147
        }
7148
 
7149
      if (hasColon)
7150
        badInput = (*argptr == ':');    /* we have class::method */
7151
      else
7152
        badInput = !isdigit (*arg);     /* not a line number */
7153
    }
7154
 
7155
  if (badInput)
7156
    printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
7157
  else
7158
    break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7159
}
7160
 
7161
/* accessflag:  hw_write:  watch write,
7162
                hw_read:   watch read,
7163
                hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
7164
static void
7165
watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
7166
{
7167
  struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7168
  struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
7169
  struct expression *exp;
7170
  struct block *exp_valid_block;
7171
  struct value *val, *mark;
7172
  struct frame_info *frame;
7173
  char *exp_start = NULL;
7174
  char *exp_end = NULL;
7175
  char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
7176
  int toklen;
7177
  char *cond_start = NULL;
7178
  char *cond_end = NULL;
7179
  int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
7180
  enum bptype bp_type;
7181
  int mem_cnt = 0;
7182
  int thread = -1;
7183
 
7184
  /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse.  */
7185
  if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
7186
    {
7187
      toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list.  */
7188
 
7189
      /* Points tok to the end of the argument list.  */
7190
      tok = arg + toklen - 1;
7191
 
7192
      /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last parameter.
7193
         If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, this should
7194
         be the thread identifier.  */
7195
      while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7196
        tok--;
7197
      while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7198
        tok--;
7199
 
7200
      /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token.  */
7201
      id_tok_start = tok + 1;
7202
 
7203
      /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more parameter.
7204
         If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, we should
7205
         reach a "thread" token.  */
7206
      while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7207
        tok--;
7208
 
7209
      end_tok = tok;
7210
 
7211
      while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7212
        tok--;
7213
 
7214
      /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
7215
         calculate the length of the token.  */
7216
      tok++;
7217
      toklen = end_tok - tok;
7218
 
7219
      if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7220
        {
7221
          /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
7222
             the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
7223
             only in a specific thread.  */
7224
          char *endp;
7225
 
7226
          /* Extract the thread ID from the next token.  */
7227
          thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
7228
 
7229
          /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
7230
             thread ID.  */
7231
          if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7232
            error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
7233
 
7234
          /* Check if the thread actually exists.  */
7235
          if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
7236
            error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
7237
 
7238
          /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
7239
             parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
7240
             evaluate_expression() function.  */
7241
          *tok = '\0';
7242
        }
7243
    }
7244
 
7245
  /* Parse the rest of the arguments.  */
7246
  innermost_block = NULL;
7247
  exp_start = arg;
7248
  exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
7249
  exp_end = arg;
7250
  /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
7251
     This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
7252
     prettier.  */
7253
  while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
7254
    --exp_end;
7255
 
7256
  exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7257
  mark = value_mark ();
7258
  fetch_watchpoint_value (exp, &val, NULL, NULL);
7259
  if (val != NULL)
7260
    release_value (val);
7261
 
7262
  tok = arg;
7263
  while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7264
    tok++;
7265
  end_tok = tok;
7266
 
7267
  while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7268
    end_tok++;
7269
 
7270
  toklen = end_tok - tok;
7271
  if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7272
    {
7273
      struct expression *cond;
7274
 
7275
      tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7276
      cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
7277
      xfree (cond);
7278
      cond_end = tok;
7279
    }
7280
  if (*tok)
7281
    error (_("Junk at end of command."));
7282
 
7283
  if (accessflag == hw_read)
7284
    bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
7285
  else if (accessflag == hw_access)
7286
    bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
7287
  else
7288
    bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
7289
 
7290
  mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
7291
  if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7292
    error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
7293
  if (mem_cnt != 0)
7294
    {
7295
      i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
7296
      target_resources_ok =
7297
        target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
7298
                                            other_type_used);
7299
      if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7300
        error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
7301
 
7302
      if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7303
        error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
7304
    }
7305
 
7306
  /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a hardware
7307
     watchpoint could not be set.  */
7308
  if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
7309
    bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
7310
 
7311
  frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
7312
 
7313
  /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
7314
     breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
7315
     expression.  Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
7316
     that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status.  */
7317
  if (innermost_block && frame)
7318
    {
7319
      if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7320
        {
7321
          scope_breakpoint
7322
            = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7323
                                          frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
7324
                                          bp_watchpoint_scope);
7325
 
7326
          scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7327
 
7328
          /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits.  */
7329
          scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
7330
 
7331
          /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion).  */
7332
          scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
7333
 
7334
          /* Set the address at which we will stop.  */
7335
          scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
7336
            = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
7337
          scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
7338
            = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7339
          scope_breakpoint->loc->address
7340
            = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
7341
                                         scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
7342
                                         scope_breakpoint->type);
7343
        }
7344
    }
7345
 
7346
  /* Now set up the breakpoint.  */
7347
  b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
7348
  set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7349
  b->number = breakpoint_count;
7350
  b->thread = thread;
7351
  b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
7352
  b->exp = exp;
7353
  b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
7354
  b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
7355
  b->val = val;
7356
  b->val_valid = 1;
7357
  if (cond_start)
7358
    b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
7359
  else
7360
    b->cond_string = 0;
7361
 
7362
  if (frame)
7363
    {
7364
      b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
7365
      b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
7366
    }
7367
  else
7368
    {
7369
      b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
7370
      b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
7371
    }
7372
 
7373
  if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
7374
    {
7375
      /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint.  We will
7376
         need to act on them together.  */
7377
      b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
7378
      scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
7379
    }
7380
 
7381
  value_free_to_mark (mark);
7382
 
7383
  /* Finally update the new watchpoint.  This creates the locations
7384
     that should be inserted.  */
7385
  update_watchpoint (b, 1);
7386
 
7387
  mention (b);
7388
  update_global_location_list (1);
7389
}
7390
 
7391
/* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled
7392
   in hardware.  If the watchpoint can not be handled
7393
   in hardware return zero.  */
7394
 
7395
static int
7396
can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
7397
{
7398
  int found_memory_cnt = 0;
7399
  struct value *head = v;
7400
 
7401
  /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
7402
  if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
7403
    return 0;
7404
 
7405
  /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
7406
     memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB.  If we
7407
     find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
7408
     hardware watchpoint.
7409
 
7410
     The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
7411
     of values, one holding the value of every subexpression.  (The
7412
     expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
7413
     a*b+c.)  GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
7414
     the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
7415
     register lvalues, computed values, etcetera.  So we can evaluate
7416
     the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
7417
     behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
7418
     expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
7419
 
7420
     However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
7421
     function calls are special in any way.  So this function may not
7422
     notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
7423
     can't be watched with hardware watchpoints.  FIXME.  */
7424
  for (; v; v = value_next (v))
7425
    {
7426
      if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
7427
        {
7428
          if (value_lazy (v))
7429
            /* A lazy memory lvalue is one that GDB never needed to fetch;
7430
               we either just used its address (e.g., `a' in `a.b') or
7431
               we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' in `a,b').  */
7432
            ;
7433
          else
7434
            {
7435
              /* Ahh, memory we actually used!  Check if we can cover
7436
                 it with hardware watchpoints.  */
7437
              struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
7438
 
7439
              /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
7440
                 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
7441
                 middle of some value chain.  */
7442
              if (v == head
7443
                  || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7444
                      && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
7445
                {
7446
                  CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
7447
                  int       len   = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
7448
 
7449
                  if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
7450
                    return 0;
7451
                  else
7452
                    found_memory_cnt++;
7453
                }
7454
            }
7455
        }
7456
      else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
7457
               && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
7458
        return 0;        /* ??? What does this represent? */
7459
      else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
7460
        return 0;        /* cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint */
7461
    }
7462
 
7463
  /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
7464
     watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it.  */
7465
  return found_memory_cnt;
7466
}
7467
 
7468
void
7469
watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7470
{
7471
  watch_command (arg, from_tty);
7472
}
7473
 
7474
static void
7475
watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7476
{
7477
  watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
7478
}
7479
 
7480
void
7481
rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7482
{
7483
  rwatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7484
}
7485
 
7486
static void
7487
rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7488
{
7489
  watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
7490
}
7491
 
7492
void
7493
awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7494
{
7495
  awatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7496
}
7497
 
7498
static void
7499
awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7500
{
7501
  watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
7502
}
7503
 
7504
 
7505
/* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c.  Here
7506
   because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints.  */
7507
 
7508
struct until_break_command_continuation_args
7509
{
7510
  struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7511
  struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
7512
};
7513
 
7514
/* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
7515
   cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
7516
   care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
7517
   command. */
7518
static void
7519
until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
7520
{
7521
  struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
7522
 
7523
  delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
7524
  if (a->breakpoint2)
7525
    delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
7526
}
7527
 
7528
void
7529
until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
7530
{
7531
  struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7532
  struct symtab_and_line sal;
7533
  struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
7534
  struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7535
  struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
7536
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
7537
 
7538
  clear_proceed_status ();
7539
 
7540
  /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
7541
     this function */
7542
 
7543
  if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7544
    sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7545
                          default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7546
  else
7547
    sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
7548
                          0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7549
 
7550
  if (sals.nelts != 1)
7551
    error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
7552
 
7553
  sal = sals.sals[0];
7554
  xfree (sals.sals);    /* malloc'd, so freed */
7555
 
7556
  if (*arg)
7557
    error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7558
 
7559
  resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
7560
 
7561
  if (anywhere)
7562
    /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
7563
       we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop.  */
7564
    breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7565
                                           null_frame_id, bp_until);
7566
  else
7567
    /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only
7568
       at the very same frame.  */
7569
    breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7570
                                           get_stack_frame_id (frame),
7571
                                           bp_until);
7572
 
7573
  old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
7574
 
7575
  /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
7576
     one.  */
7577
 
7578
  if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7579
    {
7580
      sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
7581
      sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7582
      breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7583
                                              sal,
7584
                                              frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
7585
                                              bp_until);
7586
      make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
7587
    }
7588
 
7589
  proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
7590
 
7591
  /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has actually
7592
     managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to be
7593
     deleted when the target stops.  Otherwise, we're already stopped and
7594
     delete breakpoints via cleanup chain.  */
7595
 
7596
  if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
7597
    {
7598
      struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
7599
      args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
7600
 
7601
      args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
7602
      args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
7603
 
7604
      discard_cleanups (old_chain);
7605
      add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
7606
                        until_break_command_continuation, args,
7607
                        xfree);
7608
    }
7609
  else
7610
    do_cleanups (old_chain);
7611
}
7612
 
7613
static void
7614
ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
7615
{
7616
  if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
7617
    return;
7618
  while (isspace (**s))
7619
    *s += 1;
7620
}
7621
 
7622
/* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
7623
   from the arg string.  If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7624
 
7625
   Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string.  (It does not
7626
   attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.)  And,
7627
   it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
7628
   if clause in the arg string. */
7629
 
7630
static char *
7631
ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
7632
{
7633
  char *cond_string;
7634
 
7635
  if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
7636
    return NULL;
7637
 
7638
  /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
7639
  (*arg) += 2;
7640
 
7641
  /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
7642
     condition string. */
7643
  ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
7644
  cond_string = *arg;
7645
 
7646
  /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg string. */
7647
  (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
7648
 
7649
  return cond_string;
7650
}
7651
 
7652
/* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
7653
   process start/exit, etc.  */
7654
 
7655
typedef enum
7656
{
7657
  catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
7658
  catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
7659
}
7660
catch_fork_kind;
7661
 
7662
static void
7663
catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7664
{
7665
  struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7666
  char *cond_string = NULL;
7667
  catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
7668
  int tempflag;
7669
 
7670
  fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
7671
  tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
7672
              || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
7673
 
7674
  if (!arg)
7675
    arg = "";
7676
  ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7677
 
7678
  /* The allowed syntax is:
7679
     catch [v]fork
7680
     catch [v]fork if <cond>
7681
 
7682
     First, check if there's an if clause. */
7683
  cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7684
 
7685
  if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7686
    error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7687
 
7688
  /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
7689
     and enable reporting of such events. */
7690
  switch (fork_kind)
7691
    {
7692
    case catch_fork_temporary:
7693
    case catch_fork_permanent:
7694
      create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7695
                                          &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
7696
      break;
7697
    case catch_vfork_temporary:
7698
    case catch_vfork_permanent:
7699
      create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7700
                                          &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
7701
      break;
7702
    default:
7703
      error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
7704
      break;
7705
    }
7706
}
7707
 
7708
static void
7709
catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7710
{
7711
  struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7712
  int tempflag;
7713
  char *cond_string = NULL;
7714
 
7715
  tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7716
 
7717
  if (!arg)
7718
    arg = "";
7719
  ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7720
 
7721
  /* The allowed syntax is:
7722
     catch exec
7723
     catch exec if <cond>
7724
 
7725
     First, check if there's an if clause. */
7726
  cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7727
 
7728
  if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7729
    error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7730
 
7731
  /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
7732
     and enable reporting of such events. */
7733
  create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7734
                     &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
7735
}
7736
 
7737
static enum print_stop_action
7738
print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7739
{
7740
  int bp_temp, bp_throw;
7741
 
7742
  annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7743
 
7744
  bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7745
  if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
7746
    breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
7747
                                   b->loc->address,
7748
                                   b->number, 1);
7749
  bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7750
  ui_out_text (uiout,
7751
               bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
7752
                       : "Catchpoint ");
7753
  if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7754
    ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7755
  ui_out_text (uiout,
7756
               bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
7757
                        : " (exception caught), ");
7758
  if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7759
    {
7760
      ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7761
                           async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
7762
      ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7763
      ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7764
    }
7765
  return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7766
}
7767
 
7768
static void
7769
print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7770
{
7771
  struct value_print_options opts;
7772
  get_user_print_options (&opts);
7773
  if (opts.addressprint)
7774
    {
7775
      annotate_field (4);
7776
      if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
7777
        ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
7778
      else
7779
        ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
7780
                                b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
7781
    }
7782
  annotate_field (5);
7783
  if (b->loc)
7784
    *last_loc = b->loc;
7785
  if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
7786
    ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
7787
  else
7788
    ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
7789
}
7790
 
7791
static void
7792
print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7793
{
7794
  int bp_temp;
7795
  int bp_throw;
7796
 
7797
  bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7798
  bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7799
  ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
7800
                              : _("Catchpoint "));
7801
  ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7802
  ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
7803
                               : _(" (catch)"));
7804
}
7805
 
7806
static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
7807
  NULL, /* insert */
7808
  NULL, /* remove */
7809
  NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
7810
  print_exception_catchpoint,
7811
  print_one_exception_catchpoint,
7812
  print_mention_exception_catchpoint
7813
};
7814
 
7815
static int
7816
handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
7817
                          enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
7818
{
7819
  char *trigger_func_name;
7820
 
7821
  if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7822
    trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
7823
  else
7824
    trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
7825
 
7826
  break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
7827
                        trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
7828
 
7829
                        tempflag, 0, 0,
7830
                        0,
7831
                        AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
7832
                        &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
7833
                        1 /* enabled */);
7834
 
7835
  return 1;
7836
}
7837
 
7838
/* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands */
7839
 
7840
static void
7841
catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
7842
                           int tempflag, int from_tty)
7843
{
7844
  char *cond_string = NULL;
7845
  struct symtab_and_line *sal = NULL;
7846
 
7847
  if (!arg)
7848
    arg = "";
7849
  ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7850
 
7851
  cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7852
 
7853
  if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7854
    error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7855
 
7856
  if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
7857
      && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7858
    error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
7859
 
7860
  if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
7861
    return;
7862
 
7863
  warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
7864
}
7865
 
7866
/* Implementation of "catch catch" command.  */
7867
 
7868
static void
7869
catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7870
{
7871
  int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7872
  catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7873
}
7874
 
7875
/* Implementation of "catch throw" command.  */
7876
 
7877
static void
7878
catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7879
{
7880
  int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7881
  catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7882
}
7883
 
7884
/* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints.  */
7885
 
7886
static void
7887
create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7888
                                 struct symtab_and_line sal,
7889
                                 char *addr_string,
7890
                                 char *exp_string,
7891
                                 char *cond_string,
7892
                                 struct expression *cond,
7893
                                 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
7894
                                 int tempflag,
7895
                                 int from_tty)
7896
{
7897
  struct breakpoint *b;
7898
 
7899
  if (from_tty)
7900
    {
7901
      struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
7902
      if (!loc_gdbarch)
7903
        loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
7904
 
7905
      describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
7906
                                  sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
7907
      /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
7908
         version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
7909
         used for different exception names will use the same address.
7910
         In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
7911
         unproductive.  Besides. the warning phrasing is also a bit
7912
         inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
7913
         the user what type of catchpoint it is.  The above is good
7914
         enough for now, though.  */
7915
    }
7916
 
7917
  b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
7918
  set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7919
 
7920
  b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7921
  b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7922
  b->number = breakpoint_count;
7923
  b->ignore_count = 0;
7924
  b->loc->cond = cond;
7925
  b->addr_string = addr_string;
7926
  b->language = language_ada;
7927
  b->cond_string = cond_string;
7928
  b->exp_string = exp_string;
7929
  b->thread = -1;
7930
  b->ops = ops;
7931
 
7932
  mention (b);
7933
  update_global_location_list (1);
7934
}
7935
 
7936
/* Implement the "catch exception" command.  */
7937
 
7938
static void
7939
catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
7940
                             struct cmd_list_element *command)
7941
{
7942
  struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7943
  int tempflag;
7944
  struct symtab_and_line sal;
7945
  enum bptype type;
7946
  char *addr_string = NULL;
7947
  char *exp_string = NULL;
7948
  char *cond_string = NULL;
7949
  struct expression *cond = NULL;
7950
  struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
7951
 
7952
  tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7953
 
7954
  if (!arg)
7955
    arg = "";
7956
  sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
7957
                                       &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
7958
  create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
7959
                                   cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
7960
                                   from_tty);
7961
}
7962
 
7963
/* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list.  */
7964
static void
7965
clean_up_filters (void *arg)
7966
{
7967
  VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
7968
  VEC_free (int, iter);
7969
}
7970
 
7971
/* Splits the argument using space as delimiter.  Returns an xmalloc'd
7972
   filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required.  */
7973
static VEC(int) *
7974
catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
7975
{
7976
  VEC(int) *result = NULL;
7977
  struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
7978
 
7979
  while (*arg != '\0')
7980
    {
7981
      int i, syscall_number;
7982
      char *endptr;
7983
      char cur_name[128];
7984
      struct syscall s;
7985
 
7986
      /* Skip whitespace.  */
7987
      while (isspace (*arg))
7988
        arg++;
7989
 
7990
      for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
7991
        cur_name[i] = arg[i];
7992
      cur_name[i] = '\0';
7993
      arg += i;
7994
 
7995
      /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number.  */
7996
      syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
7997
      if (*endptr == '\0')
7998
        get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
7999
      else
8000
        {
8001
          /* We have a name.  Let's check if it's valid and convert it
8002
             to a number.  */
8003
          get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
8004
 
8005
          if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
8006
            /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning, because
8007
               GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no syscall number to
8008
               be caught.  */
8009
            error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
8010
        }
8011
 
8012
      /* Ok, it's valid.  */
8013
      VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
8014
    }
8015
 
8016
  discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8017
  return result;
8018
}
8019
 
8020
/* Implement the "catch syscall" command.  */
8021
 
8022
static void
8023
catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8024
{
8025
  int tempflag;
8026
  VEC(int) *filter;
8027
  struct syscall s;
8028
  struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8029
 
8030
  /* Checking if the feature if supported.  */
8031
  if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
8032
    error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
8033
this architeture yet."));
8034
 
8035
  tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8036
 
8037
  ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8038
 
8039
  /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
8040
     to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
8041
     to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
8042
     for his/her architecture.  */
8043
  get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
8044
 
8045
  /* The allowed syntax is:
8046
     catch syscall
8047
     catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
8048
 
8049
     Let's check if there's a syscall name.  */
8050
 
8051
  if (arg != NULL)
8052
    filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
8053
  else
8054
    filter = NULL;
8055
 
8056
  create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
8057
                                   &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8058
}
8059
 
8060
/* Implement the "catch assert" command.  */
8061
 
8062
static void
8063
catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8064
{
8065
  struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8066
  int tempflag;
8067
  struct symtab_and_line sal;
8068
  char *addr_string = NULL;
8069
  struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8070
 
8071
  tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8072
 
8073
  if (!arg)
8074
    arg = "";
8075
  sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
8076
  create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
8077
                                   ops, tempflag, from_tty);
8078
}
8079
 
8080
static void
8081
catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8082
{
8083
  error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8084
}
8085
 
8086
 
8087
static void
8088
tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8089
{
8090
  error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8091
}
8092
 
8093
/* Delete breakpoints by address or line.  */
8094
 
8095
static void
8096
clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8097
{
8098
  struct breakpoint *b;
8099
  VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
8100
  int ix;
8101
  int default_match;
8102
  struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8103
  struct symtab_and_line sal;
8104
  int i;
8105
 
8106
  if (arg)
8107
    {
8108
      sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
8109
      default_match = 0;
8110
    }
8111
  else
8112
    {
8113
      sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8114
        xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8115
      make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
8116
      init_sal (&sal);          /* initialize to zeroes */
8117
      sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
8118
      sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
8119
      sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
8120
      sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
8121
      if (sal.symtab == 0)
8122
        error (_("No source file specified."));
8123
 
8124
      sals.sals[0] = sal;
8125
      sals.nelts = 1;
8126
 
8127
      default_match = 1;
8128
    }
8129
 
8130
  /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not
8131
     as bad as it seems, because all existing breakpoints
8132
     typically have both file/line and pc set.  So, if
8133
     clear is given file/line, we can match this to existing
8134
     breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
8135
 
8136
     We only support clearing given the address explicitly
8137
     present in breakpoint table.  Say, we've set breakpoint
8138
     at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
8139
     due to optimization, all in one block.
8140
     We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
8141
     PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
8142
     be cleared.  We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
8143
     since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
8144
     can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
8145
     to support that.  */
8146
 
8147
  /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond
8148
     to it.  Do it in two passes, solely to preserve the current
8149
     behavior that from_tty is forced true if we delete more than
8150
     one breakpoint.  */
8151
 
8152
  found = NULL;
8153
  for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
8154
    {
8155
      /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
8156
         If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
8157
         If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
8158
         or at default pc.
8159
 
8160
         defaulting    sal.pc != 0    tests to do
8161
 
8162
 
8163
         1              1             pc _and_ line
8164
 
8165
         1              0             <can't happen> */
8166
 
8167
      sal = sals.sals[i];
8168
 
8169
      /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to
8170
         'found'.  */
8171
      ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8172
        {
8173
          int match = 0;
8174
          /* Are we going to delete b? */
8175
          if (b->type != bp_none
8176
              && b->type != bp_watchpoint
8177
              && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
8178
              && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
8179
              && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
8180
            {
8181
              struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
8182
              for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8183
                {
8184
                  int pc_match = sal.pc
8185
                    && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
8186
                    && (loc->address == sal.pc)
8187
                    && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
8188
                        || loc->section == sal.section);
8189
                  int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
8190
                                    && b->source_file != NULL
8191
                                    && sal.symtab != NULL
8192
                                    && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
8193
                                    && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
8194
                                    && b->line_number == sal.line);
8195
                  if (pc_match || line_match)
8196
                    {
8197
                      match = 1;
8198
                      break;
8199
                    }
8200
                }
8201
            }
8202
 
8203
          if (match)
8204
            VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
8205
        }
8206
    }
8207
  /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them.  */
8208
  if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
8209
    {
8210
      if (arg)
8211
        error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
8212
      else
8213
        error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
8214
    }
8215
 
8216
  if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
8217
    from_tty = 1;               /* Always report if deleted more than one */
8218
  if (from_tty)
8219
    {
8220
      if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
8221
        printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
8222
      else
8223
        printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
8224
    }
8225
  breakpoints_changed ();
8226
 
8227
  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
8228
    {
8229
      if (from_tty)
8230
        printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
8231
      delete_breakpoint (b);
8232
    }
8233
  if (from_tty)
8234
    putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
8235
}
8236
 
8237
/* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
8238
   all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
8239
   This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors.  */
8240
 
8241
void
8242
breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
8243
{
8244
  struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8245
 
8246
  for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
8247
    if (bs->breakpoint_at
8248
        && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
8249
        && bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del
8250
        && bs->stop)
8251
      delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner);
8252
 
8253
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8254
  {
8255
    if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
8256
      delete_breakpoint (b);
8257
  }
8258
}
8259
 
8260
/* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to qsort.
8261
   Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what does
8262
   breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), secondarily by ordering
8263
   first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and terciarily just ensuring the array
8264
   is sorted stable way despite qsort being an instable algorithm.  */
8265
 
8266
static int
8267
bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
8268
{
8269
  struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
8270
  struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
8271
  int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8272
  int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8273
 
8274
  if (a->address != b->address)
8275
    return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
8276
 
8277
  /* Sort permanent breakpoints first.  */
8278
  if (a_perm != b_perm)
8279
    return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
8280
 
8281
  /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs.  Locations of the same
8282
     breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order.  */
8283
 
8284
  if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
8285
    return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
8286
           - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
8287
 
8288
  return (a > b) - (a < b);
8289
}
8290
 
8291
/* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
8292
   bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current content of
8293
   the bp_location array.  */
8294
 
8295
static void
8296
bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
8297
{
8298
  struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
8299
 
8300
  bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
8301
  bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
8302
 
8303
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
8304
    {
8305
      CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
8306
 
8307
      if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
8308
        continue;
8309
 
8310
      start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
8311
      end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
8312
 
8313
      gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
8314
      addr = bl->address - start;
8315
      if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
8316
        bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
8317
 
8318
      /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow.  */
8319
 
8320
      gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
8321
      addr = end - bl->address;
8322
      if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
8323
        bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
8324
    }
8325
}
8326
 
8327
/* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
8328
   into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
8329
   longer should be inserted.  Functions that delete a breakpoint or
8330
   breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
8331
   doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
8332
   breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
8333
   returns true on them.
8334
 
8335
   This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
8336
   after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
8337
   shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
8338
   to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
8339
   execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
8340
   breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior.  */
8341
 
8342
static void
8343
update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
8344
{
8345
  struct breakpoint *b;
8346
  struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
8347
  struct cleanup *cleanups;
8348
 
8349
  /* Used in the duplicates detection below.  When iterating over all
8350
     bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
8351
     Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
8352
     duplicates of each other.  Keep one pointer for each type of
8353
     breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
8354
     once.  */
8355
  struct bp_location *bp_loc_first;  /* breakpoint */
8356
  struct bp_location *wp_loc_first;  /* hardware watchpoint */
8357
  struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
8358
  struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
8359
 
8360
  /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly built
8361
     bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS.  */
8362
  struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
8363
  unsigned old_location_count;
8364
 
8365
  old_location = bp_location;
8366
  old_location_count = bp_location_count;
8367
  bp_location = NULL;
8368
  bp_location_count = 0;
8369
  cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
8370
 
8371
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8372
    for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8373
      bp_location_count++;
8374
 
8375
  bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
8376
  locp = bp_location;
8377
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8378
    for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8379
      *locp++ = loc;
8380
  qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
8381
         bp_location_compare);
8382
 
8383
  bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
8384
 
8385
  /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the new
8386
     list, and therefore should be freed.  Note that it's not necessary that
8387
     those locations should be removed from inferior -- if there's another
8388
     location at the same address (previously marked as duplicate),
8389
     we don't need to remove/insert the location.
8390
 
8391
     LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current and
8392
     former bp_location array state respectively.  */
8393
 
8394
  locp = bp_location;
8395
  for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
8396
       old_locp++)
8397
    {
8398
      struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
8399
      struct bp_location **loc2p;
8400
 
8401
      /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations.  If not, we
8402
         have to free it.  */
8403
      int found_object = 0;
8404
      /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target.  */
8405
      int keep_in_target = 0;
8406
      int removed = 0;
8407
 
8408
      /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.  Stop either
8409
         at or being the one matching OLD_LOC.  */
8410
      while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
8411
             && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
8412
        locp++;
8413
 
8414
      for (loc2p = locp;
8415
           (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8416
            && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8417
           loc2p++)
8418
        {
8419
          if (*loc2p == old_loc)
8420
            {
8421
              found_object = 1;
8422
              break;
8423
            }
8424
        }
8425
 
8426
      /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if there's
8427
         maybe a new location at the same address.  If so, mark that one
8428
         inserted, and don't remove this one.  This is needed so that we
8429
         don't have a time window where a breakpoint at certain location is not
8430
         inserted.  */
8431
 
8432
      if (old_loc->inserted)
8433
        {
8434
          /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove it.  */
8435
 
8436
          if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
8437
            {
8438
              /* The location is still present in the location list, and still
8439
                 should be inserted.  Don't do anything.  */
8440
              keep_in_target = 1;
8441
            }
8442
          else
8443
            {
8444
              /* The location is either no longer present, or got disabled.
8445
                 See if there's another location at the same address, in which
8446
                 case we don't need to remove this one from the target.  */
8447
 
8448
              if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
8449
                {
8450
                  for (loc2p = locp;
8451
                       (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8452
                        && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8453
                       loc2p++)
8454
                    {
8455
                      struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
8456
 
8457
                      if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
8458
                        {
8459
                          /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
8460
                             Duplicates check below will fix up this later.  */
8461
                          loc2->duplicate = 0;
8462
                          if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
8463
                            {
8464
                              loc2->inserted = 1;
8465
                              loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
8466
                              keep_in_target = 1;
8467
                              break;
8468
                            }
8469
                        }
8470
                    }
8471
                }
8472
            }
8473
 
8474
          if (!keep_in_target)
8475
            {
8476
              if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
8477
                {
8478
                  /* This is just about all we can do.  We could keep this
8479
                     location on the global list, and try to remove it next
8480
                     time, but there's no particular reason why we will
8481
                     succeed next time.
8482
 
8483
                     Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still valid,
8484
                     as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint only
8485
                     after calling us.  */
8486
                  printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
8487
                                   old_loc->owner->number);
8488
                }
8489
              removed = 1;
8490
            }
8491
        }
8492
 
8493
      if (!found_object)
8494
        {
8495
          if (removed && non_stop
8496
              && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
8497
              && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8498
            {
8499
              /* This location was removed from the target.  In
8500
                 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
8501
                 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
8502
                 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
8503
                 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
8504
                 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
8505
                 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
8506
                 after we see some number of events.  The theory here
8507
                 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
8508
                 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
8509
                 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
8510
                 need to keep this breakpoint location around.  We
8511
                 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
8512
                 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
8513
                 SIGTRAP.
8514
 
8515
                 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
8516
                 decr_pc_after_break targets.
8517
 
8518
                 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
8519
                 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
8520
                 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
8521
                 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
8522
                 a random SIGTRAP to the user.  When the user resumes
8523
                 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
8524
                 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SEGSEGV, or worse, get silently
8525
                 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
8526
                 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
8527
                 one-byte instruction.  This was actually seen happen
8528
                 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
8529
                 targets that do not support new thread events, like
8530
                 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
8531
                 thread_count.
8532
 
8533
                 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
8534
                 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
8535
                 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
8536
                 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
8537
 
8538
                 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
8539
                 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
8540
                 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
8541
                 around.  We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
8542
                 traps we can no longer explain.  */
8543
 
8544
              old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
8545
              old_loc->owner = NULL;
8546
 
8547
              VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
8548
            }
8549
          else
8550
            free_bp_location (old_loc);
8551
        }
8552
    }
8553
 
8554
  /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
8555
     first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates".  This is so
8556
     that the bpt instruction is only inserted once.  If we have a
8557
     permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
8558
     official one, and the rest as duplicates.  Permanent breakpoints
8559
     are sorted first for the same address.
8560
 
8561
     Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
8562
     watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length.  */
8563
 
8564
  bp_loc_first = NULL;
8565
  wp_loc_first = NULL;
8566
  awp_loc_first = NULL;
8567
  rwp_loc_first = NULL;
8568
  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
8569
    {
8570
      struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
8571
      struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
8572
 
8573
      if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
8574
          || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
8575
          || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
8576
          || !loc->enabled
8577
          || loc->shlib_disabled
8578
          || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
8579
          || tracepoint_type (b))
8580
        continue;
8581
 
8582
      /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted.  */
8583
      if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
8584
        internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8585
                        _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
8586
                        "actually inserted"));
8587
 
8588
      if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8589
        loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
8590
      else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
8591
        loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
8592
      else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
8593
        loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
8594
      else
8595
        loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
8596
 
8597
      if (*loc_first_p == NULL
8598
          || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
8599
          || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
8600
        {
8601
          *loc_first_p = loc;
8602
          loc->duplicate = 0;
8603
          continue;
8604
        }
8605
 
8606
      loc->duplicate = 1;
8607
 
8608
      if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
8609
          && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
8610
        internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8611
                        _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
8612
                        "a permanent breakpoint"));
8613
    }
8614
 
8615
  if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
8616
      && (have_live_inferiors ()
8617
          || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
8618
    insert_breakpoint_locations ();
8619
 
8620
  do_cleanups (cleanups);
8621
}
8622
 
8623
void
8624
breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
8625
{
8626
  struct bp_location *loc;
8627
  int ix;
8628
 
8629
  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
8630
    if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
8631
      {
8632
        free_bp_location (loc);
8633
        VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
8634
        --ix;
8635
      }
8636
}
8637
 
8638
static void
8639
update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
8640
{
8641
  struct gdb_exception e;
8642
  TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8643
    update_global_location_list (inserting);
8644
}
8645
 
8646
/* Clear BPT from a BPS.  */
8647
static void
8648
bpstat_remove_breakpoint (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
8649
{
8650
  bpstat bs;
8651
  for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
8652
    if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->owner == bpt)
8653
      {
8654
        bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
8655
        bs->old_val = NULL;
8656
        /* bs->commands will be freed later.  */
8657
      }
8658
}
8659
 
8660
/* Callback for iterate_over_threads.  */
8661
static int
8662
bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
8663
{
8664
  struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
8665
  bpstat_remove_breakpoint (th->stop_bpstat, bpt);
8666
  return 0;
8667
}
8668
 
8669
/* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
8670
   structures. */
8671
 
8672
void
8673
delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
8674
{
8675
  struct breakpoint *b;
8676
  struct bp_location *loc, *next;
8677
 
8678
  gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
8679
 
8680
  /* Has this bp already been deleted?  This can happen because multiple
8681
     lists can hold pointers to bp's.  bpstat lists are especial culprits.
8682
 
8683
     One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp.  When the
8684
     scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of scope, and
8685
     delete it.  We also delete its scope bp.  But the scope bp is marked
8686
     "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.  That bpstat is then
8687
     checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are deleted.
8688
 
8689
     A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in bp's,
8690
     and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing bpstat's, and
8691
     teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's storage when no more
8692
     references were extent.  A cheaper bandaid was chosen.  */
8693
  if (bpt->type == bp_none)
8694
    return;
8695
 
8696
  /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting of
8697
     breakpoints gets resolved.  */
8698
  if (bpt->related_breakpoint != NULL)
8699
    {
8700
      gdb_assert (bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == bpt);
8701
      bpt->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
8702
      bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
8703
      bpt->related_breakpoint = NULL;
8704
    }
8705
 
8706
  observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
8707
 
8708
  if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
8709
    breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
8710
 
8711
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8712
    if (b->next == bpt)
8713
    {
8714
      b->next = bpt->next;
8715
      break;
8716
    }
8717
 
8718
  free_command_lines (&bpt->commands);
8719
  if (bpt->cond_string != NULL)
8720
    xfree (bpt->cond_string);
8721
  if (bpt->addr_string != NULL)
8722
    xfree (bpt->addr_string);
8723
  if (bpt->exp != NULL)
8724
    xfree (bpt->exp);
8725
  if (bpt->exp_string != NULL)
8726
    xfree (bpt->exp_string);
8727
  if (bpt->val != NULL)
8728
    value_free (bpt->val);
8729
  if (bpt->source_file != NULL)
8730
    xfree (bpt->source_file);
8731
  if (bpt->exec_pathname != NULL)
8732
    xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
8733
  clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
8734
 
8735
  /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at it after it's been freed.  */
8736
  /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?
8737
     We just check stop_bpstat for now.  Note that we cannot just
8738
     remove bpstats pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list
8739
     entirely, as breakpoint commands are associated with the bpstat;
8740
     if we remove it here, then the later call to
8741
         bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat);
8742
     in event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints
8743
     with commands won't work.  */
8744
 
8745
  iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
8746
 
8747
  /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint
8748
     list, update the global location list.  This
8749
     will remove locations that used to belong to
8750
     this breakpoint.  Do this before freeing
8751
     the breakpoint itself, since remove_breakpoint
8752
     looks at location's owner.  It might be better
8753
     design to have location completely self-contained,
8754
     but it's not the case now.  */
8755
  update_global_location_list (0);
8756
 
8757
 
8758
  /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this same
8759
     bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
8760
  bpt->type = bp_none;
8761
 
8762
  xfree (bpt);
8763
}
8764
 
8765
static void
8766
do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
8767
{
8768
  delete_breakpoint (b);
8769
}
8770
 
8771
struct cleanup *
8772
make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8773
{
8774
  return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
8775
}
8776
 
8777
void
8778
delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8779
{
8780
  struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8781
 
8782
  dont_repeat ();
8783
 
8784
  if (arg == 0)
8785
    {
8786
      int breaks_to_delete = 0;
8787
 
8788
      /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
8789
         Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
8790
         have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument.  */
8791
      ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8792
      {
8793
        if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8794
            && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8795
            && b->type != bp_jit_event
8796
            && b->type != bp_thread_event
8797
            && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8798
            && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8799
            && b->number >= 0)
8800
          {
8801
            breaks_to_delete = 1;
8802
            break;
8803
          }
8804
      }
8805
 
8806
      /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete.  */
8807
      if (!from_tty
8808
          || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
8809
        {
8810
          ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8811
          {
8812
            if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8813
                && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8814
                && b->type != bp_thread_event
8815
                && b->type != bp_jit_event
8816
                && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8817
                && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8818
                && b->number >= 0)
8819
              delete_breakpoint (b);
8820
          }
8821
        }
8822
    }
8823
  else
8824
    map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
8825
}
8826
 
8827
static int
8828
all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
8829
{
8830
  for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8831
    if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
8832
      return 0;
8833
  return 1;
8834
}
8835
 
8836
/* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
8837
   Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
8838
   Null names are ignored.  */
8839
 
8840
static int
8841
ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
8842
{
8843
  struct bp_location *l;
8844
  htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
8845
                                   (int (*) (const void *, const void *)) streq,
8846
                                   NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
8847
 
8848
  for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
8849
    {
8850
      const char **slot;
8851
      const char *name = l->function_name;
8852
 
8853
      /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them.  */
8854
      if (name == NULL)
8855
        continue;
8856
 
8857
      slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
8858
                                             INSERT);
8859
      /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never returns
8860
         NULL.  */
8861
      if (*slot != NULL)
8862
        {
8863
          htab_delete (htab);
8864
          return 1;
8865
        }
8866
      *slot = name;
8867
    }
8868
 
8869
  htab_delete (htab);
8870
  return 0;
8871
}
8872
 
8873
static void
8874
update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
8875
                             struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
8876
{
8877
  int i;
8878
  char *s;
8879
  struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
8880
 
8881
  /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations
8882
     are pending, don't do anything.  This optimizes
8883
     the common case where all locations are in the same
8884
     shared library, that was unloaded. We'd like to
8885
     retain the location, so that when the library
8886
     is loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled
8887
     status of the individual locations.  */
8888
  if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
8889
    return;
8890
 
8891
  b->loc = NULL;
8892
 
8893
  for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
8894
    {
8895
      struct bp_location *new_loc =
8896
        add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
8897
 
8898
      /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
8899
         old symtab.  */
8900
      if (b->cond_string != NULL)
8901
        {
8902
          struct gdb_exception e;
8903
 
8904
          s = b->cond_string;
8905
          TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8906
            {
8907
              new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
8908
                                           0);
8909
            }
8910
          if (e.reason < 0)
8911
            {
8912
              warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
8913
                       b->number, e.message);
8914
              new_loc->enabled = 0;
8915
            }
8916
        }
8917
 
8918
      if (b->source_file != NULL)
8919
        xfree (b->source_file);
8920
      if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
8921
        b->source_file = NULL;
8922
      else
8923
        b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
8924
 
8925
      if (b->line_number == 0)
8926
        b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
8927
    }
8928
 
8929
  /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints.  */
8930
  if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
8931
    make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
8932
 
8933
  /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing breakpoints.  */
8934
  {
8935
    struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
8936
    /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
8937
       e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
8938
       Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
8939
       may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
8940
       often enough until a better solution is found.  */
8941
    int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
8942
 
8943
    for (; e; e = e->next)
8944
      {
8945
        if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
8946
          {
8947
            struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
8948
            if (have_ambiguous_names)
8949
              {
8950
                for (; l; l = l->next)
8951
                  if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
8952
                                                l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
8953
                    {
8954
                      l->enabled = 0;
8955
                      break;
8956
                    }
8957
              }
8958
            else
8959
              {
8960
                for (; l; l = l->next)
8961
                  if (l->function_name
8962
                      && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
8963
                    {
8964
                      l->enabled = 0;
8965
                      break;
8966
                    }
8967
              }
8968
          }
8969
      }
8970
  }
8971
 
8972
  update_global_location_list (1);
8973
}
8974
 
8975
 
8976
/* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
8977
   The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
8978
   Unused in this case.  */
8979
 
8980
static int
8981
breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
8982
{
8983
  /* get past catch_errs */
8984
  struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
8985
  struct value *mark;
8986
  int i;
8987
  int not_found = 0;
8988
  int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
8989
  struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
8990
  struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
8991
  char *s;
8992
  enum enable_state save_enable;
8993
  struct gdb_exception e;
8994
  struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
8995
 
8996
  switch (b->type)
8997
    {
8998
    case bp_none:
8999
      warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9000
               b->number);
9001
      return 0;
9002
    case bp_breakpoint:
9003
    case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9004
    case bp_tracepoint:
9005
    case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9006
      /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup.  */
9007
      if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
9008
        return 0;
9009
 
9010
      if (b->addr_string == NULL)
9011
        {
9012
          /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
9013
          delete_breakpoint (b);
9014
          return 0;
9015
        }
9016
 
9017
      set_language (b->language);
9018
      input_radix = b->input_radix;
9019
      s = b->addr_string;
9020
 
9021
      save_current_space_and_thread ();
9022
      switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
9023
 
9024
      TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9025
        {
9026
          sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
9027
                                not_found_ptr);
9028
        }
9029
      if (e.reason < 0)
9030
        {
9031
          int not_found_and_ok = 0;
9032
          /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing
9033
             will fail until the right shared library is loaded.
9034
             User has already told to create pending breakpoints and
9035
             don't need extra messages.  If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
9036
             state, then user already saw the message about that breakpoint
9037
             being disabled, and don't want to see more errors.  */
9038
          if (not_found
9039
              && (b->condition_not_parsed
9040
                  || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
9041
                  || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
9042
            not_found_and_ok = 1;
9043
 
9044
          if (!not_found_and_ok)
9045
            {
9046
              /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
9047
                 10 times.  One solution, implemented here, is disable
9048
                 the breakpoint on error.  Another solution would be to
9049
                 have separate 'warning emitted' flag.  Since this
9050
                 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
9051
                 which approach is better.  */
9052
              b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9053
              throw_exception (e);
9054
            }
9055
        }
9056
 
9057
      if (!not_found)
9058
        {
9059
          gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
9060
 
9061
          resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
9062
          if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
9063
            {
9064
              char *cond_string = 0;
9065
              int thread = -1;
9066
              int task = 0;
9067
 
9068
              find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
9069
                                         &cond_string, &thread, &task);
9070
              if (cond_string)
9071
                b->cond_string = cond_string;
9072
              b->thread = thread;
9073
              b->task = task;
9074
              b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
9075
            }
9076
 
9077
          expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
9078
        }
9079
 
9080
      make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9081
      update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
9082
      break;
9083
 
9084
    case bp_watchpoint:
9085
    case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9086
    case bp_read_watchpoint:
9087
    case bp_access_watchpoint:
9088
      /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global variables,
9089
         or it can be on local variables.
9090
 
9091
         Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even persist
9092
         across program restarts. Since they can use variables from shared
9093
         libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries are loaded
9094
         and unloaded.
9095
 
9096
         Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9097
         of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local and
9098
         a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, but
9099
         unloading of a shared library will make the expression invalid.
9100
         This is not a very common use case, but we still re-evaluate
9101
         expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9102
 
9103
         Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9104
         watchpoints frame id is still valid.  If it's not, it means
9105
         the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9106
         I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9107
 
9108
         If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9109
         b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9110
 
9111
         Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
9112
         be reevaluated again when enabled.  */
9113
      update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
9114
      break;
9115
      /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
9116
         that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
9117
         loaded. */
9118
    case bp_catchpoint:
9119
      break;
9120
 
9121
    default:
9122
      printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
9123
      /* fall through */
9124
      /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
9125
         reset later by breakpoint_re_set.  */
9126
    case bp_overlay_event:
9127
    case bp_longjmp_master:
9128
      delete_breakpoint (b);
9129
      break;
9130
 
9131
      /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
9132
         starts and we really don't want to touch it.  */
9133
    case bp_shlib_event:
9134
 
9135
      /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
9136
         Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it.  */
9137
    case bp_thread_event:
9138
 
9139
      /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
9140
         over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
9141
         Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
9142
         or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable.  */
9143
    case bp_until:
9144
    case bp_finish:
9145
    case bp_watchpoint_scope:
9146
    case bp_call_dummy:
9147
    case bp_step_resume:
9148
    case bp_longjmp:
9149
    case bp_longjmp_resume:
9150
    case bp_jit_event:
9151
      break;
9152
    }
9153
 
9154
  do_cleanups (cleanups);
9155
  return 0;
9156
}
9157
 
9158
/* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded.  */
9159
void
9160
breakpoint_re_set (void)
9161
{
9162
  struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9163
  enum language save_language;
9164
  int save_input_radix;
9165
  struct cleanup *old_chain;
9166
 
9167
  save_language = current_language->la_language;
9168
  save_input_radix = input_radix;
9169
  old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
9170
 
9171
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9172
  {
9173
    /* Format possible error msg */
9174
    char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
9175
                                b->number);
9176
    struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
9177
    catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
9178
    do_cleanups (cleanups);
9179
  }
9180
  set_language (save_language);
9181
  input_radix = save_input_radix;
9182
 
9183
  jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
9184
 
9185
  do_cleanups (old_chain);
9186
 
9187
  create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
9188
  create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
9189
  create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
9190
  create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
9191
  create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
9192
}
9193
 
9194
/* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
9195
 
9196
   - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
9197
   - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
9198
void
9199
breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
9200
{
9201
  if (b->thread != -1)
9202
    {
9203
      if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9204
        b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9205
 
9206
      /* We're being called after following a fork.  The new fork is
9207
         selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
9208
         different program space from the original thread.  Reset that
9209
         as well.  */
9210
      b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
9211
    }
9212
}
9213
 
9214
/* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9215
   If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9216
   which ends with a period (no newline).  */
9217
 
9218
void
9219
set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
9220
{
9221
  struct breakpoint *b;
9222
 
9223
  if (count < 0)
9224
    count = 0;
9225
 
9226
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9227
    if (b->number == bptnum)
9228
    {
9229
      b->ignore_count = count;
9230
      if (from_tty)
9231
        {
9232
          if (count == 0)
9233
            printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
9234
                             bptnum);
9235
          else if (count == 1)
9236
            printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
9237
                             bptnum);
9238
          else
9239
            printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
9240
                             count, bptnum);
9241
        }
9242
      breakpoints_changed ();
9243
      observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
9244
      return;
9245
    }
9246
 
9247
  error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
9248
}
9249
 
9250
void
9251
make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
9252
{
9253
  /* Silence the breakpoint.  */
9254
  b->silent = 1;
9255
}
9256
 
9257
/* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT.  */
9258
 
9259
static void
9260
ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9261
{
9262
  char *p = args;
9263
  int num;
9264
 
9265
  if (p == 0)
9266
    error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
9267
 
9268
  num = get_number (&p);
9269
  if (num == 0)
9270
    error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
9271
  if (*p == 0)
9272
    error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
9273
 
9274
  set_ignore_count (num,
9275
                    longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
9276
                    from_tty);
9277
  if (from_tty)
9278
    printf_filtered ("\n");
9279
}
9280
 
9281
/* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
9282
   whose numbers are given in ARGS.  */
9283
 
9284
static void
9285
map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *))
9286
{
9287
  char *p = args;
9288
  char *p1;
9289
  int num;
9290
  struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
9291
  int match;
9292
 
9293
  if (p == 0)
9294
    error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
9295
 
9296
  while (*p)
9297
    {
9298
      match = 0;
9299
      p1 = p;
9300
 
9301
      num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9302
      if (num == 0)
9303
        {
9304
          warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
9305
        }
9306
      else
9307
        {
9308
          ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
9309
            if (b->number == num)
9310
              {
9311
                struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
9312
                match = 1;
9313
                function (b);
9314
                if (related_breakpoint)
9315
                  function (related_breakpoint);
9316
                break;
9317
              }
9318
          if (match == 0)
9319
            printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
9320
        }
9321
      p = p1;
9322
    }
9323
}
9324
 
9325
static struct bp_location *
9326
find_location_by_number (char *number)
9327
{
9328
  char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
9329
  char *p1;
9330
  int bp_num;
9331
  int loc_num;
9332
  struct breakpoint *b;
9333
  struct bp_location *loc;
9334
 
9335
  *dot = '\0';
9336
 
9337
  p1 = number;
9338
  bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9339
  if (bp_num == 0)
9340
    error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9341
 
9342
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9343
    if (b->number == bp_num)
9344
      {
9345
        break;
9346
      }
9347
 
9348
  if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
9349
    error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9350
 
9351
  p1 = dot+1;
9352
  loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9353
  if (loc_num == 0)
9354
    error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
9355
 
9356
  --loc_num;
9357
  loc = b->loc;
9358
  for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
9359
    ;
9360
  if (!loc)
9361
    error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
9362
 
9363
  return loc;
9364
}
9365
 
9366
 
9367
/* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9368
   If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9369
   which ends with a period (no newline).  */
9370
 
9371
void
9372
disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9373
{
9374
  /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
9375
     hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
9376
     watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time.  */
9377
  if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
9378
    return;
9379
 
9380
  /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints.  */
9381
  if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9382
    return;
9383
 
9384
  bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9385
 
9386
  update_global_location_list (0);
9387
 
9388
  observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9389
}
9390
 
9391
static void
9392
disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9393
{
9394
  struct breakpoint *bpt;
9395
  if (args == 0)
9396
    ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9397
      switch (bpt->type)
9398
      {
9399
      case bp_none:
9400
        warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9401
                 bpt->number);
9402
        continue;
9403
      case bp_breakpoint:
9404
      case bp_tracepoint:
9405
      case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9406
      case bp_catchpoint:
9407
      case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9408
      case bp_watchpoint:
9409
      case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9410
      case bp_read_watchpoint:
9411
      case bp_access_watchpoint:
9412
        disable_breakpoint (bpt);
9413
      default:
9414
        continue;
9415
      }
9416
  else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9417
    {
9418
      struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9419
      if (loc)
9420
        loc->enabled = 0;
9421
      update_global_location_list (0);
9422
    }
9423
  else
9424
    map_breakpoint_numbers (args, disable_breakpoint);
9425
}
9426
 
9427
static void
9428
do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
9429
{
9430
  int target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
9431
  struct value *mark;
9432
 
9433
  if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9434
    {
9435
      int i;
9436
      i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9437
      target_resources_ok =
9438
        target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9439
                                            i + 1, 0);
9440
      if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9441
        error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9442
      else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9443
        error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9444
    }
9445
 
9446
  if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint
9447
      || bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9448
      || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
9449
      || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9450
    {
9451
      struct gdb_exception e;
9452
 
9453
      TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9454
        {
9455
          update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
9456
        }
9457
      if (e.reason < 0)
9458
        {
9459
          exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
9460
                             bpt->number);
9461
          return;
9462
        }
9463
    }
9464
 
9465
  if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9466
    bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9467
  bpt->disposition = disposition;
9468
  update_global_location_list (1);
9469
  breakpoints_changed ();
9470
 
9471
  observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9472
}
9473
 
9474
 
9475
void
9476
enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9477
{
9478
  do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
9479
}
9480
 
9481
/* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
9482
   breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
9483
   in stopping the inferior.  */
9484
 
9485
static void
9486
enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9487
{
9488
  struct breakpoint *bpt;
9489
  if (args == 0)
9490
    ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9491
      switch (bpt->type)
9492
      {
9493
      case bp_none:
9494
        warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9495
                 bpt->number);
9496
        continue;
9497
      case bp_breakpoint:
9498
      case bp_tracepoint:
9499
      case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9500
      case bp_catchpoint:
9501
      case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9502
      case bp_watchpoint:
9503
      case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9504
      case bp_read_watchpoint:
9505
      case bp_access_watchpoint:
9506
        enable_breakpoint (bpt);
9507
      default:
9508
        continue;
9509
      }
9510
  else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9511
    {
9512
      struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9513
      if (loc)
9514
        loc->enabled = 1;
9515
      update_global_location_list (1);
9516
    }
9517
  else
9518
    map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_breakpoint);
9519
}
9520
 
9521
static void
9522
enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9523
{
9524
  do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
9525
}
9526
 
9527
static void
9528
enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9529
{
9530
  map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint);
9531
}
9532
 
9533
static void
9534
enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9535
{
9536
  do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
9537
}
9538
 
9539
static void
9540
enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9541
{
9542
  map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint);
9543
}
9544
 
9545
static void
9546
set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9547
{
9548
}
9549
 
9550
static void
9551
show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9552
{
9553
}
9554
 
9555
/* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
9556
   the memory which that value represents has been written to by
9557
   GDB itself.  */
9558
 
9559
static void
9560
invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
9561
                                      const bfd_byte *data)
9562
{
9563
  struct breakpoint *bp;
9564
 
9565
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9566
    if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
9567
        && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9568
        && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
9569
      {
9570
        struct bp_location *loc;
9571
 
9572
        for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
9573
          if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
9574
              && loc->address + loc->length > addr
9575
              && addr + len > loc->address)
9576
            {
9577
              value_free (bp->val);
9578
              bp->val = NULL;
9579
              bp->val_valid = 0;
9580
            }
9581
      }
9582
}
9583
 
9584
/* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid.  */
9585
 
9586
struct symtabs_and_lines
9587
decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
9588
{
9589
  struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9590
  if (string == 0)
9591
    error (_("Empty line specification."));
9592
  if (default_breakpoint_valid)
9593
    sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9594
                          default_breakpoint_symtab,
9595
                          default_breakpoint_line,
9596
                          (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9597
  else
9598
    sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9599
                          (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9600
  if (*string)
9601
    error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
9602
  return sals;
9603
}
9604
 
9605
/* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC.  Return an
9606
   identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
9607
   In general, places which call this should be using something on the
9608
   breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
9609
   someday.  */
9610
 
9611
void *
9612
deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9613
                                  struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9614
{
9615
  struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
9616
 
9617
  bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
9618
 
9619
  bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
9620
  bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
9621
 
9622
  if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
9623
    {
9624
      /* Could not insert the breakpoint.  */
9625
      xfree (bp_tgt);
9626
      return NULL;
9627
    }
9628
 
9629
  return bp_tgt;
9630
}
9631
 
9632
/* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint.  */
9633
 
9634
int
9635
deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
9636
{
9637
  struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
9638
  int ret;
9639
 
9640
  ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
9641
  xfree (bp_tgt);
9642
 
9643
  return ret;
9644
}
9645
 
9646
/* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single stepping.  */
9647
 
9648
static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
9649
static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
9650
 
9651
/* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step.  */
9652
 
9653
void
9654
insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9655
                               struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR next_pc)
9656
{
9657
  void **bpt_p;
9658
 
9659
  if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
9660
    {
9661
      bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
9662
      single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
9663
    }
9664
  else
9665
    {
9666
      gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
9667
      bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
9668
      single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
9669
    }
9670
 
9671
  /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would be
9672
     to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on the
9673
     breakpoint chain.  That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint.  We could
9674
     adjust the addresses each time they were needed.  Doing this requires
9675
     corresponding changes elsewhere where single step breakpoints are
9676
     handled, however.  So, for now, we use this.  */
9677
 
9678
  *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
9679
  if (*bpt_p == NULL)
9680
    error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
9681
             paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
9682
}
9683
 
9684
/* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step.  */
9685
 
9686
void
9687
remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
9688
{
9689
  gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
9690
 
9691
  /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
9692
     call.  */
9693
  deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
9694
                                    single_step_breakpoints[0]);
9695
  single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
9696
  single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
9697
 
9698
  if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
9699
    {
9700
      deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
9701
                                        single_step_breakpoints[1]);
9702
      single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
9703
      single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
9704
    }
9705
}
9706
 
9707
/* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at PC.  */
9708
 
9709
static int
9710
single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9711
{
9712
  int i;
9713
 
9714
  for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
9715
    {
9716
      struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
9717
      if (bp_tgt
9718
          && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
9719
                                       bp_tgt->placed_address,
9720
                                       aspace, pc))
9721
        return 1;
9722
    }
9723
 
9724
  return 0;
9725
}
9726
 
9727
/* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
9728
   non-zero otherwise.  */
9729
static int
9730
is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
9731
{
9732
  if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
9733
      && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
9734
      && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
9735
    return 1;
9736
  else
9737
    return 0;
9738
}
9739
 
9740
int
9741
catch_syscall_enabled (void)
9742
{
9743
  struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
9744
 
9745
  return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
9746
}
9747
 
9748
int
9749
catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
9750
{
9751
  struct breakpoint *bp;
9752
 
9753
  ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9754
    if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
9755
      {
9756
        if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
9757
          {
9758
            int i, iter;
9759
            for (i = 0;
9760
                 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
9761
                 i++)
9762
              if (syscall_number == iter)
9763
                return 1;
9764
          }
9765
        else
9766
          return 1;
9767
      }
9768
 
9769
  return 0;
9770
}
9771
 
9772
/* Complete syscall names.  Used by "catch syscall".  */
9773
static char **
9774
catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
9775
                         char *text, char *word)
9776
{
9777
  const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
9778
  return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
9779
}
9780
 
9781
/* Tracepoint-specific operations.  */
9782
 
9783
/* Set tracepoint count to NUM.  */
9784
static void
9785
set_tracepoint_count (int num)
9786
{
9787
  tracepoint_count = num;
9788
  set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
9789
}
9790
 
9791
void
9792
trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9793
{
9794
  if (break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9795
                            arg,
9796
                            NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9797
 
9798
                            1 /* traceflag */,
9799
 
9800
                            pending_break_support,
9801
                            NULL,
9802
                            from_tty,
9803
                            1 /* enabled */))
9804
    set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9805
}
9806
 
9807
void
9808
ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9809
{
9810
  if (break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9811
                            arg,
9812
                            NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9813
 
9814
                            1 /* traceflag */,
9815
 
9816
                            pending_break_support,
9817
                            NULL,
9818
                            from_tty,
9819
                            1 /* enabled */))
9820
    set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9821
}
9822
 
9823
/* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
9824
   can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
9825
   equivalent GDB tracepoint.  This is not a reliable process, since
9826
   the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
9827
   the tracepoint was originally defined.  */
9828
 
9829
struct breakpoint *
9830
create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
9831
{
9832
  char buf[100];
9833
  struct breakpoint *tp;
9834
 
9835
  /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw address.  */
9836
  sprintf (buf, "*%s", paddress (get_current_arch(), utp->addr));
9837
 
9838
  if (!break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9839
                             buf,
9840
                             NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9841
 
9842
                             (utp->type == bp_fast_tracepoint) /* hardwareflag */,
9843
                             1 /* traceflag */,
9844
 
9845
                             pending_break_support,
9846
                             NULL,
9847
 
9848
                             utp->enabled /* enabled */))
9849
    return NULL;
9850
 
9851
  set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9852
 
9853
  tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
9854
  gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
9855
 
9856
  if (utp->pass > 0)
9857
    {
9858
      sprintf (buf, "%d %d", utp->pass, tp->number);
9859
 
9860
      trace_pass_command (buf, 0);
9861
    }
9862
 
9863
  if (utp->cond)
9864
    {
9865
      printf_filtered ("Want to restore a condition\n");
9866
    }
9867
 
9868
  if (utp->numactions > 0)
9869
    {
9870
      printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
9871
    }
9872
 
9873
  if (utp->num_step_actions > 0)
9874
    {
9875
      printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
9876
    }
9877
 
9878
  return tp;
9879
  }
9880
 
9881
/* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
9882
   omitted.  */
9883
 
9884
static void
9885
tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
9886
{
9887
  struct breakpoint *b;
9888
  int tps_to_list = 0;
9889
 
9890
  /* In the no-arguments case, say "No tracepoints" if none found.  */
9891
  if (tpnum_exp == 0)
9892
    {
9893
      ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9894
      {
9895
        if (b->number >= 0)
9896
          {
9897
            tps_to_list = 1;
9898
            break;
9899
          }
9900
      }
9901
      if (!tps_to_list)
9902
        {
9903
          ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
9904
          return;
9905
        }
9906
    }
9907
 
9908
  /* Otherwise be the same as "info break".  */
9909
  breakpoints_info (tpnum_exp, from_tty);
9910
}
9911
 
9912
/* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
9913
   Not supported by all targets.  */
9914
static void
9915
enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9916
{
9917
  enable_command (args, from_tty);
9918
}
9919
 
9920
/* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
9921
   Not supported by all targets.  */
9922
static void
9923
disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9924
{
9925
  disable_command (args, from_tty);
9926
}
9927
 
9928
/* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument) */
9929
static void
9930
delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9931
{
9932
  struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9933
 
9934
  dont_repeat ();
9935
 
9936
  if (arg == 0)
9937
    {
9938
      int breaks_to_delete = 0;
9939
 
9940
      /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
9941
         Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
9942
         have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument.  */
9943
      ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9944
      {
9945
        if (b->number >= 0)
9946
          {
9947
            breaks_to_delete = 1;
9948
            break;
9949
          }
9950
      }
9951
 
9952
      /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete.  */
9953
      if (!from_tty
9954
          || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
9955
        {
9956
          ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9957
          {
9958
            if (tracepoint_type (b)
9959
                && b->number >= 0)
9960
              delete_breakpoint (b);
9961
          }
9962
        }
9963
    }
9964
  else
9965
    map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
9966
}
9967
 
9968
/* Set passcount for tracepoint.
9969
 
9970
   First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
9971
   If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
9972
   Also accepts special argument "all".  */
9973
 
9974
static void
9975
trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9976
{
9977
  struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
9978
  unsigned int count;
9979
  int all = 0;
9980
 
9981
  if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
9982
    error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
9983
 
9984
  count = strtoul (args, &args, 10);    /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
9985
 
9986
  while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
9987
    args++;
9988
 
9989
  if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
9990
    {
9991
      args += 3;                        /* Skip special argument "all".  */
9992
      all = 1;
9993
      if (*args)
9994
        error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9995
    }
9996
  else
9997
    t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
9998
 
9999
  do
10000
    {
10001
      if (t1)
10002
        {
10003
          ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
10004
            if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
10005
              {
10006
                t2->pass_count = count;
10007
                observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
10008
                if (from_tty)
10009
                  printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
10010
                                   t2->number, count);
10011
              }
10012
          if (! all && *args)
10013
            t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
10014
        }
10015
    }
10016
  while (*args);
10017
}
10018
 
10019
struct breakpoint *
10020
get_tracepoint (int num)
10021
{
10022
  struct breakpoint *t;
10023
 
10024
  ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10025
    if (t->number == num)
10026
      return t;
10027
 
10028
  return NULL;
10029
}
10030
 
10031
/* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
10032
   different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
10033
   reconnecting).  */
10034
 
10035
struct breakpoint *
10036
get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
10037
{
10038
  struct breakpoint *t;
10039
 
10040
  ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10041
    if (t->number_on_target == num)
10042
      return t;
10043
 
10044
  return NULL;
10045
}
10046
 
10047
/* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
10048
   If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
10049
   if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
10050
   recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned.  */
10051
struct breakpoint *
10052
get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
10053
{
10054
  extern int tracepoint_count;
10055
  struct breakpoint *t;
10056
  int tpnum;
10057
  char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
10058
 
10059
  if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
10060
    {
10061
      if (optional_p)
10062
        tpnum = tracepoint_count;
10063
      else
10064
        error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
10065
    }
10066
  else
10067
    tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
10068
 
10069
  if (tpnum <= 0)
10070
    {
10071
      if (instring && *instring)
10072
        printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
10073
                         instring);
10074
      else
10075
        printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
10076
      return NULL;
10077
    }
10078
 
10079
  ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10080
    if (t->number == tpnum)
10081
    {
10082
      return t;
10083
    }
10084
 
10085
  /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
10086
     a message.  The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
10087
     allow us to discover this.  */
10088
  printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
10089
  return NULL;
10090
}
10091
 
10092
/* save-tracepoints command */
10093
static void
10094
tracepoint_save_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10095
{
10096
  struct breakpoint *tp;
10097
  int any_tp = 0;
10098
  struct action_line *line;
10099
  FILE *fp;
10100
  char *i1 = "    ", *i2 = "      ";
10101
  char *indent, *actionline, *pathname;
10102
  char tmp[40];
10103
  struct cleanup *cleanup;
10104
 
10105
  if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
10106
    error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save tracepoints)"));
10107
 
10108
  /* See if we have anything to save.  */
10109
  ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10110
  {
10111
    any_tp = 1;
10112
    break;
10113
  }
10114
  if (!any_tp)
10115
    {
10116
      warning (_("save-tracepoints: no tracepoints to save."));
10117
      return;
10118
    }
10119
 
10120
  pathname = tilde_expand (args);
10121
  cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
10122
  fp = fopen (pathname, "w");
10123
  if (!fp)
10124
    error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving tracepoints (%s)"),
10125
           args, safe_strerror (errno));
10126
  make_cleanup_fclose (fp);
10127
 
10128
  ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10129
  {
10130
    if (tp->addr_string)
10131
      fprintf (fp, "trace %s\n", tp->addr_string);
10132
    else
10133
      {
10134
        sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
10135
        fprintf (fp, "trace *0x%s\n", tmp);
10136
      }
10137
 
10138
    if (tp->pass_count)
10139
      fprintf (fp, "  passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
10140
 
10141
    if (tp->actions)
10142
      {
10143
        fprintf (fp, "  actions\n");
10144
        indent = i1;
10145
        for (line = tp->actions; line; line = line->next)
10146
          {
10147
            struct cmd_list_element *cmd;
10148
 
10149
            QUIT;               /* allow user to bail out with ^C */
10150
            actionline = line->action;
10151
            while (isspace ((int) *actionline))
10152
              actionline++;
10153
 
10154
            fprintf (fp, "%s%s\n", indent, actionline);
10155
            if (*actionline != '#')     /* skip for comment lines */
10156
              {
10157
                cmd = lookup_cmd (&actionline, cmdlist, "", -1, 1);
10158
                if (cmd == 0)
10159
                  error (_("Bad action list item: %s"), actionline);
10160
                if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, while_stepping_pseudocommand))
10161
                  indent = i2;
10162
                else if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, end_actions_pseudocommand))
10163
                  indent = i1;
10164
              }
10165
          }
10166
      }
10167
  }
10168
  do_cleanups (cleanup);
10169
  if (from_tty)
10170
    printf_filtered (_("Tracepoints saved to file '%s'.\n"), args);
10171
  return;
10172
}
10173
 
10174
/* Create a vector of all tracepoints.  */
10175
 
10176
VEC(breakpoint_p) *
10177
all_tracepoints ()
10178
{
10179
  VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
10180
  struct breakpoint *tp;
10181
 
10182
  ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10183
  {
10184
    VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
10185
  }
10186
 
10187
  return tp_vec;
10188
}
10189
 
10190
 
10191
/* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak commands.
10192
   It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
10193
   COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the command.  */
10194
#define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
10195
command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
10196
LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10197
If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
10198
If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
10199
If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
10200
With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of selected stack frame.\n\
10201
This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
10202
\n\
10203
THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
10204
CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
10205
\n\
10206
Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if conditional.\n\
10207
\n\
10208
Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
10209
 
10210
/* List of subcommands for "catch".  */
10211
static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
10212
 
10213
/* List of subcommands for "tcatch".  */
10214
static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
10215
 
10216
/* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
10217
   lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function.  */
10218
static void
10219
add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
10220
                   void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
10221
                                  struct cmd_list_element *command),
10222
                   char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10223
                                         char *text, char *word),
10224
                   void *user_data_catch,
10225
                   void *user_data_tcatch)
10226
{
10227
  struct cmd_list_element *command;
10228
 
10229
  command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10230
                     &catch_cmdlist);
10231
  set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10232
  set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
10233
  set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10234
 
10235
  command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10236
                     &tcatch_cmdlist);
10237
  set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10238
  set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
10239
  set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10240
}
10241
 
10242
static void
10243
clear_syscall_counts (int pid)
10244
{
10245
  struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
10246
 
10247
  inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
10248
  inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
10249
  VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
10250
}
10251
 
10252
void
10253
_initialize_breakpoint (void)
10254
{
10255
  static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
10256
  static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
10257
  struct cmd_list_element *c;
10258
 
10259
  observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
10260
  observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
10261
  observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
10262
 
10263
  breakpoint_chain = 0;
10264
  /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count.  $bpnum isn't useful
10265
     before a breakpoint is set.  */
10266
  breakpoint_count = 0;
10267
 
10268
  tracepoint_count = 0;
10269
 
10270
  add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
10271
Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
10272
Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
10273
  if (xdb_commands)
10274
    add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
10275
 
10276
  add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
10277
Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
10278
Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
10279
With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
10280
The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
10281
Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
10282
Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
10283
then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
10284
 
10285
  add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
10286
Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
10287
Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
10288
expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
10289
 
10290
  c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
10291
Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
10292
Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10293
so it will be deleted when hit.  Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
10294
by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
10295
\n"
10296
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
10297
  set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10298
 
10299
  c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
10300
Set a hardware assisted  breakpoint.\n\
10301
Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
10302
some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
10303
\n"
10304
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
10305
  set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10306
 
10307
  c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
10308
Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10309
Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10310
so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
10311
\n"
10312
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
10313
  set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10314
 
10315
  add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10316
Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10317
Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10318
With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10319
This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10320
With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
10321
                  &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10322
  if (xdb_commands)
10323
    add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10324
Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10325
Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10326
With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10327
This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10328
With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
10329
 
10330
  add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10331
 
10332
  add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10333
Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10334
Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10335
This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10336
May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
10337
                   &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
10338
 
10339
  add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10340
Enable breakpoints for one hit.  Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10341
If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10342
           &enablebreaklist);
10343
 
10344
  add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10345
Enable breakpoints and delete when hit.  Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10346
If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10347
           &enablebreaklist);
10348
 
10349
  add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10350
Enable breakpoints and delete when hit.  Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10351
If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10352
           &enablelist);
10353
 
10354
  add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10355
Enable breakpoints for one hit.  Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10356
If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10357
           &enablelist);
10358
 
10359
  add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10360
Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10361
Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10362
To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10363
A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
10364
                  &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10365
  add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10366
  add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10367
  if (xdb_commands)
10368
    add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10369
Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10370
Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10371
To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10372
A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
10373
 
10374
  add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
10375
Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10376
Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10377
To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10378
A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
10379
This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
10380
           &disablelist);
10381
 
10382
  add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10383
Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10384
Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10385
To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10386
\n\
10387
Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
10388
The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
10389
                  &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
10390
  add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10391
  add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10392
  if (xdb_commands)
10393
    add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10394
Delete some breakpoints.\n\
10395
Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10396
To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
10397
 
10398
  add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
10399
Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10400
Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10401
To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10402
This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
10403
           &deletelist);
10404
 
10405
  add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
10406
Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
10407
Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10408
If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
10409
If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
10410
If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
10411
\n\
10412
With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
10413
is executing in.\n\
10414
\n\
10415
See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
10416
 
10417
  c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
10418
Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
10419
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
10420
  set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10421
 
10422
  add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
10423
  add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
10424
  add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
10425
  add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
10426
 
10427
  if (xdb_commands)
10428
   add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
10429
 
10430
  if (dbx_commands)
10431
    {
10432
      add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
10433
Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
10434
                             &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
10435
      add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
10436
               _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
10437
      add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
10438
               _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
10439
      add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
10440
Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10441
The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10442
\tbreakpoint     - normal breakpoint\n\
10443
\twatchpoint     - watchpoint\n\
10444
The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10445
the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit.  \"dis\" means that the\n\
10446
breakpoint will be disabled.  The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10447
address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10448
\n\
10449
Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10450
are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10451
is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10452
Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10453
breakpoint set."));
10454
    }
10455
 
10456
  add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
10457
Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10458
The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10459
\tbreakpoint     - normal breakpoint\n\
10460
\twatchpoint     - watchpoint\n\
10461
The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10462
the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit.  \"dis\" means that the\n\
10463
breakpoint will be disabled.  The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10464
address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10465
\n\
10466
Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10467
are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10468
is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10469
Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10470
breakpoint set."));
10471
 
10472
  add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
10473
 
10474
  if (xdb_commands)
10475
    add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
10476
Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10477
The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10478
\tbreakpoint     - normal breakpoint\n\
10479
\twatchpoint     - watchpoint\n\
10480
The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10481
the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit.  \"dis\" means that the\n\
10482
breakpoint will be disabled.  The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10483
address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10484
\n\
10485
Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10486
are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10487
is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10488
Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10489
breakpoint set."));
10490
 
10491
  add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
10492
Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10493
The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10494
\tbreakpoint     - normal breakpoint\n\
10495
\twatchpoint     - watchpoint\n\
10496
\tlongjmp        - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
10497
\tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
10498
\tuntil          - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
10499
\tfinish         - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
10500
The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10501
the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit.  \"dis\" means that the\n\
10502
breakpoint will be disabled.  The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10503
address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10504
\n\
10505
Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10506
are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10507
is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10508
Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10509
breakpoint set."),
10510
           &maintenanceinfolist);
10511
 
10512
  add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
10513
Set catchpoints to catch events."),
10514
                  &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
10515
                  0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10516
 
10517
  add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
10518
Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
10519
                  &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
10520
                  0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10521
 
10522
  /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands.  */
10523
  add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
10524
Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
10525
With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10526
                     catch_catch_command,
10527
                     NULL,
10528
                     CATCH_PERMANENT,
10529
                     CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10530
  add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
10531
Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
10532
With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10533
                     catch_throw_command,
10534
                     NULL,
10535
                     CATCH_PERMANENT,
10536
                     CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10537
  add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
10538
                     catch_fork_command_1,
10539
                     NULL,
10540
                     (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
10541
                     (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
10542
  add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
10543
                     catch_fork_command_1,
10544
                     NULL,
10545
                     (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
10546
                     (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
10547
  add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
10548
                     catch_exec_command_1,
10549
                     NULL,
10550
                     CATCH_PERMANENT,
10551
                     CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10552
  add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
10553
Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
10554
Arguments say which system calls to catch.  If no arguments\n\
10555
are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
10556
Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
10557
(if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
10558
                     catch_syscall_command_1,
10559
                     catch_syscall_completer,
10560
                     CATCH_PERMANENT,
10561
                     CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10562
  add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
10563
Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
10564
With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10565
                     catch_ada_exception_command,
10566
                     NULL,
10567
                     CATCH_PERMANENT,
10568
                     CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10569
  add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
10570
Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
10571
With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10572
                     catch_assert_command,
10573
                     NULL,
10574
                     CATCH_PERMANENT,
10575
                     CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10576
 
10577
  c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
10578
Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10579
A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10580
an expression changes."));
10581
  set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10582
 
10583
  c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
10584
Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10585
A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10586
an expression is read."));
10587
  set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10588
 
10589
  c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
10590
Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10591
A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10592
an expression is either read or written."));
10593
  set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10594
 
10595
  add_info ("watchpoints", breakpoints_info,
10596
            _("Synonym for ``info breakpoints''."));
10597
 
10598
 
10599
  /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
10600
     respond to changes - contrary to the description.  */
10601
  add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
10602
                            &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
10603
Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10604
Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10605
If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
10606
such is available.  (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
10607
created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
10608
hardware.)"),
10609
                            NULL,
10610
                            show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
10611
                            &setlist, &showlist);
10612
 
10613
  can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
10614
 
10615
  /* Tracepoint manipulation commands.  */
10616
 
10617
  c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
10618
Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10619
\n"
10620
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
10621
Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10622
  set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10623
 
10624
  add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
10625
  add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10626
  add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10627
  add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10628
 
10629
  c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
10630
Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10631
\n"
10632
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
10633
Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10634
  set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10635
 
10636
  add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
10637
Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
10638
Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
10639
last tracepoint set."));
10640
 
10641
  add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
10642
 
10643
  add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
10644
Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
10645
Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10646
No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
10647
           &deletelist);
10648
 
10649
  c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
10650
Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
10651
Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10652
No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
10653
           &disablelist);
10654
  deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
10655
 
10656
  c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
10657
Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
10658
Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10659
No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
10660
           &enablelist);
10661
  deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
10662
 
10663
  add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
10664
Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
10665
The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
10666
Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
10667
if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
10668
 
10669
  c = add_com ("save-tracepoints", class_trace, tracepoint_save_command, _("\
10670
Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
10671
Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."));
10672
  set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
10673
 
10674
  add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10675
Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10676
Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10677
pending breakpoint behavior"),
10678
                  &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
10679
                  0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
10680
  add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10681
Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10682
Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10683
pending breakpoint behavior"),
10684
                  &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
10685
                  0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
10686
 
10687
  add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
10688
                                &pending_break_support, _("\
10689
Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10690
Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10691
If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
10692
pending breakpoint.  If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
10693
an error.  If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
10694
user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
10695
                                NULL,
10696
                                show_pending_break_support,
10697
                                &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10698
                                &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10699
 
10700
  pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
10701
 
10702
  add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
10703
                           &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
10704
Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10705
Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10706
If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
10707
breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory.  If not set,\n\
10708
a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
10709
                           NULL,
10710
                           show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
10711
                           &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10712
                           &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10713
 
10714
  add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
10715
                        always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
10716
Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10717
Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10718
When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
10719
resumed, and removed when execution stops.  When this mode is on,\n\
10720
breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
10721
deletes the breakpoint.  When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
10722
the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
10723
In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
10724
behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
10725
inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
10726
                           NULL,
10727
                           &show_always_inserted_mode,
10728
                           &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10729
                           &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10730
 
10731
  automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
10732
 
10733
  observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
10734
}

powered by: WebSVN 2.1.0

© copyright 1999-2024 OpenCores.org, equivalent to Oliscience, all rights reserved. OpenCores®, registered trademark.